Attached files

file filename
EX-32 - EX-32 - PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPd839505dex32.htm
EX-23.1 - EX-23.1 - PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPd839505dex231.htm
EX-31.2 - EX-31.2 - PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPd839505dex312.htm
EX-31.1 - EX-31.1 - PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPd839505dex311.htm
EXCEL - IDEA: XBRL DOCUMENT - PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPFinancial_Report.xls
EX-10.10 - EX-10.10 - PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPd839505dex1010.htm
EX-10.11 - EX-10.11 - PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPd839505dex1011.htm
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM 10-K

 

 

(Mark one)

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2014

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

FOR THE TRANSITION PERIOD FROM             TO             

COMMISSION FILE NUMBER 0-30106

 

 

PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPORATION

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 

 

OREGON   93-1269184
(State or Other Jurisdiction
of Incorporation or Organization)
  (IRS Employer
Identification No)
111 West 7th Avenue  
Eugene, Oregon   97401
(Address of principal executive offices)   (zip code)

(541) 686-8685

(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of Each Class

 

Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered

Common Stock, No par value per share   NASDAQ Global Select Market

Securities registered pursuant to section 12(g) of the Act:

None

 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities

Act.     Yes  ¨    No   x

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate website, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (check one)

 

Large accelerated filer   ¨    Accelerated filer   x
Non-accelerated filer   ¨    Smaller Reporting Company   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant at June 30, 2014 (the last business day of the most recently completed second quarter) was 234,599,636 based on the closing price as quoted on the NASDAQ Global Select Market on that date.

The number of shares outstanding of the registrant’s common stock, no par value, as of February 28, 2015, was 17,718,778.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

All or a portion of Items 10 through 14 in Part III of this Form 10-K are incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A, which will be filed within 120 days after the close of the fiscal year covered by this report on Form 10-K, or if the Registrant’s Schedule 14A is not filed within such period, will be included in an amendment to this Report on Form 10-K which will be filed within such 120 day period.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPORATION

FORM 10-K

ANNUAL REPORT

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

         Page  
PART I        3   

ITEM 1

  Business      3   

ITEM 1A

  Risk Factors      24   

ITEM 1B

  Unresolved Staff Comments      31   

ITEM 2

  Properties      32   

ITEM 3

  Legal Proceedings      32   

ITEM 4

  Mine Safety Disclosure      33   

PART II

     34   

ITEM 5

  Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities      34   

ITEM 6

 

Selected Financial Data

     37   

ITEM 7

  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operation      38   

ITEM 7A

  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk      57   

ITEM 8

  Financial Statements and Supplementary Data      60   

ITEM 9

  Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure      119   

ITEM 9A

  Controls and Procedures      119   

ITEM 9B

  Other Information      119   

PART III

     120   

ITEM 10

  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance      120   

ITEM 11

  Executive Compensation      120   

ITEM 12

  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters      120   

ITEM 13

  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions and Director Independence      120   

ITEM 14

  Principal Accountant Fees and Services      120   

PART IV

     120   

ITEM 15

  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules      120   

SIGNATURES

     120   

CERTIFICATIONS

  

 

2


Table of Contents

PART I

 

ITEM 1 Business

In addition to historical information, this report contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. These forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, statements regarding projected results for 2015, factors that could impact the Company’s financial results, the expected interest rate environment, 2015 provision for loan losses, the possibility of valuation write-downs on OREO, management’s plans, objectives, expectations and intentions that are not historical facts, and other statements identified by words such as “expects,” “anticipates,” “intends,” “plans,” “believes,” “should,” “projects,” “seeks,” “estimates” or words of similar meaning. These forward-looking statements are based on current beliefs and expectations of management and are inherently subject to significant business, economic and competitive uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond the Company’s control. In addition, these forward-looking statements are subject to assumptions with respect to future business strategies and decisions that are subject to change. The following factors, among others, could cause actual results to differ materially from the anticipated results or other expectations in the forward-looking statements, including those set forth in this report, or the documents incorporated by reference:

 

    Local and national economic conditions could be less favorable than expected or could have a more direct and pronounced effect on us than expected and adversely affect our ability to continue growth at historical rates and maintain the quality of our earning assets.

 

    The local housing or real estate market could decline.

 

    The risks presented by an economic recession, which could adversely affect credit quality, collateral values, including real estate collateral, investment values, liquidity and loan originations and loan portfolio delinquency rates.

 

    Our concentration in loans to dental professionals exposes us to the risks affecting dental practices in general, including Medicaid and Medicare reimbursement programs and changes due to the Affordable Care Act.

 

    Interest rate changes could significantly reduce net interest income and negatively affect funding sources.

 

    Projected business increases following our acquisition of Capital Pacific Bancorp or any future strategic expansion or opening of new branches could be lower than expected.

 

    Competition among financial institutions could increase significantly.

 

    The goodwill we have recorded in connection with acquisitions could become impaired, which may have an adverse impact on our reported earnings.

 

    The reputation of the financial services industry could deteriorate, which could adversely affect our ability to access markets for funding and to acquire and retain customers.

 

    The efficiencies we may expect to receive from any investments in personnel, acquisitions and infrastructure may not be realized.

 

    The level of nonperforming assets and charge-offs or changes in the estimates of future reserve requirements based upon the periodic review thereof under relevant regulatory and accounting requirements may increase.

 

    Changes in laws and regulations (including laws and regulations concerning taxes, banking, securities, executive compensation and insurance) could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

    Acts of war or terrorism, or natural disasters, such as the effects of pandemic flu, may adversely impact our business.

 

    The timely development and acceptance of new banking products and services and perceived overall value of these products and services by users may adversely impact our ability to increase market share and control expenses.

 

    Changes in accounting policies and practices, as may be adopted by the regulatory agencies, as well as the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, the Financial Accounting Standards Board and other accounting standard setters, may impact the results of our operations.

 

    The costs and effects of legal and regulatory developments including the resolution of legal proceedings or regulatory or other governmental inquiries and the results of regulatory examinations or reviews may adversely impact our ability to increase market share and control expenses and may adversely affect our results of operations and future prospects.

 

    Our success at managing the risks involved in the foregoing items will have a significant impact on our results of operations and future prospects.

 

3


Table of Contents

Additional factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in any forward-looking statements are discussed in Risk Factors in this Form 10-K. Please take into account that forward-looking statements speak only as of the date of this report or documents incorporated by reference. The Company does not undertake any obligation to publicly correct or update any forward-looking statement whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.

General

Pacific Continental Corporation (the “Company” or the “Registrant”) is an Oregon corporation and registered bank holding company headquartered in Eugene, Oregon. The Company was organized on June 7, 1999, pursuant to a holding company reorganization of Pacific Continental Bank, its wholly owned subsidiary (the “Bank”).

The Company’s principal business activities are conducted through the Bank, an Oregon state-chartered bank with deposits insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”). The Bank has no active subsidiaries.

Results and Financial Data

All dollar amounts in the following sections are in thousands except per share amounts or where otherwise indicated.

For the year ended December 31, 2014, the consolidated net income of the Company was $16,042 or $0.89 per diluted share. At December 31, 2014, the consolidated shareholders’ equity of the Company was $184,161 with 17,717,676 shares outstanding and a book value of $10.39 per share. Total assets were $1,504,325 at December 31, 2014. Loans net of allowance for loan losses and unearned fees were $1,029,384 at December 31, 2014, and represented 68.43% of total assets. Deposits totaled $1,209,093 at year-end 2014, with Company-defined core deposits representing $1,110,861, or 91.88% of total deposits. Core deposits are defined as all demand, interest checking, money market, savings and local non-public time deposits, including local non-public time deposits in excess of $100. At December 31, 2014, the Company had a Tier 1 leverage capital ratio, Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio, and total risk-based capital ratio, of 11.33%, 14.48% and 15.73%, respectively, all of which are significantly above the minimum “well-capitalized” level for all capital ratios under FDIC guidelines of 5.00%, 6.00% and 10.00%, respectively.

On November 19, 2014, the Company announced the acquisition of Portland-based Capital Pacific Bancorp with assets of approximately $255,900. On March 6, 2015, the Company completed the acquisition of Capital Pacific Bancorp. Capital Pacific shareholders received either $16.00 per share in cash or 1.132 shares of Pacific Continental common stock for each share of Capital Pacific common stock, or a combination of 40.00% in the form of cash and 60.00% in the form of Pacific Continental common stock. Pursuant to the merger agreement, the maximum aggregate cash consideration was $16,412, and the aggregate stock consideration to be issued to Capital Pacific shareholders consisted of 1,778,102 shares of Pacific Continental common stock. Based on the closing price of Pacific Continental common stock on March 6, 2015, the aggregate consideration payable for Capital Pacific Bancorp was valued at $39,990.

For more information regarding the Company’s financial condition and results of operations, see Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations and Financial Statements and Supplementary Data in Items 7 and 8 of this Form 10-K.

THE BANK

General

The Bank commenced operations on August 15, 1972. The Bank operates in three primary markets: Portland, Oregon / Southwest Washington, Seattle, Washington, and Eugene, Oregon. At December 31, 2014, the Bank operated fourteen full-service offices in Oregon and Washington and two loan production offices in Washington and Colorado. The primary business strategy of the Bank is to operate in large commercial markets and to provide comprehensive banking and related services tailored to community-based businesses, nonprofit organizations, professional service providers, and banking services for business owners and executives. The Bank emphasizes the diversity of its product lines, high levels of personal service and convenient access through technology typically associated with larger financial institutions, while maintaining local decision-making authority and market knowledge, typical of a community bank. The Bank has developed expertise in lending to dental professionals, and during 2014 expanded a national dental lending program. More information on the Bank and its banking

 

4


Table of Contents

services can be found on its website (therightbank.com). Information contained on the Bank’s website is not part of this Form 10-K. The Company’s Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and any amendments to these reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 are available free of charge upon request on the Bank’s website. The reports are also available on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.The Bank operates under the banking laws of the State of Oregon, and the rules and regulations of the FDIC. In addition, operations at its branches and other offices in the State of Washington are subject to various consumer protection and other laws of that state.

 

5


Table of Contents

THE COMPANY

Primary Market Area

The Company’s primary markets consist of metropolitan Portland, which includes Southwest Washington, metropolitan Eugene in the State of Oregon and metropolitan Seattle in the State of Washington. During 2014, the Company expanded its lending to dental professionals, and at year end had loans to dental professionals in 35 states, up from 30 states in 2013. The Company has five full-service banking offices in the metropolitan Portland and Southwest Washington area, seven full-service banking offices in the metropolitan Eugene area, and two full-service offices in the metropolitan Seattle area. It also operates loan production offices in Tacoma, Washington and Denver, Colorado. The Company has its headquarters and administrative office in Eugene, Oregon.

Overall, national economic conditions improved during 2014. Historically, the Pacific Northwest, which encompasses all three of the Company’s primary markets, enters a recession late and exits a recession late when compared to other areas of the country. This is particularly true for the Eugene, Oregon market. During 2014, in general, economic conditions improved in all of the Company’s primary markets in line with national general economic conditions; however, certain areas of the Pacific Northwest have fared better than others. In particular, larger metropolitan areas, such as Portland and Seattle, have seen more improvement in general economic conditions and job growth than rural areas of Oregon and Washington. As is typical, the economic conditions in the Eugene market have improved, but not at the levels realized in Portland and Seattle.

On a monthly basis, the University of Oregon, located in Eugene, Oregon, produces the Oregon Index of Economic Indicators using the year 1997 as its beginning base of 100. This index attempts to measure various components of the state of Oregon economy, including labor markets, capital goods orders, and consumer confidence, in order to determine if economic conditions in the state are improving or deteriorating, and provides the probability of a recession. This index indicated that economic activity for the state of Oregon fell to its lowest level during the first quarter 2009 when the index reached 85.0 and then generally trended upward. During 2014, the index continued upward on a quarterly basis, and for December 2014 was at 98.5, an improvement of 2.30% over the prior year-end.

The unemployment rate for the state of Oregon at December 31, 2014, was 6.70% as compared to 5.60% nationally and has been slowly trending downward since early 2009. Portland area unemployment stood at 5.80% for this same time period, slightly under the state average, and above the national average. For Lane County, Oregon (the Eugene market), the unemployment rate was 6.20%, slightly below the state average, and above the national average at December 31, 2014.

The unemployment rate for the State of Washington at December 31, 2014, was 6.30%, above the national average and has trended downward on a quarterly basis since early 2009. In King County, Washington, which includes the metropolitan Seattle area, the unemployment rate at year-end 2014 was 4.80%, below the state and national averages. The Seattle market in particular has demonstrated more economic diversity than the other primary markets in which the Company operates. All unemployment rates were provided by the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics.

At December 31, 2014, approximately 60.00% of the Company’s loan portfolio was secured by real estate, thus the condition and valuation trends of commercial and residential real estate markets in the Pacific Northwest have had a significant impact on the overall credit quality of the Company’s primary assets in that, in the event of default, the value of real estate collateral and its salability is typically the primary source of repayment. Approximately $74,000, or 7.00% of the Company’s loan portfolio, was categorized as residential and commercial construction loans, which also includes land development and acquisition loans at December 31, 2014. During 2014, the Company experienced a contraction in construction lending, centered in commercial real estate construction and multifamily construction as many of the constructions projects finished the construction phase and converted to permanent financing.

 

6


Table of Contents

Real estate markets in the Pacific Northwest were weak during the economic recession have been slow to recover. During 2014, some signs of improvement or stabilization were noted, particularly in commercial real estate markets. Commercial real estate prices firmed and appeared to be improving in 2014 based on appraisals received by the Company. In all three of the Company’s primary markets, Eugene, Portland, and Seattle, commercial real estate vacancy rates improved in 2014. However, the value of commercial bare land and partially developed commercial land in all three markets was quite weak due to weak demand. In 2014, there was very little demand for new commercial developments due to the economic conditions in the Pacific Northwest, thus there were relatively few comparable sales available to use to assess the value of certain commercial land development properties.

Residential housing prices in all three of the Company’s primary markets stabilized or improved in 2014. Small pockets of new residential construction were evident in the Portland and Seattle markets and in 2014 the value of residential bare land and partially developed residential land in all three markets was variable, depending on location, with some upward pressure.

Competition

Commercial banking in the states of Oregon and Washington is highly competitive. The Company competes with other banks, as well as with savings and loan associations, savings banks, credit unions, mortgage companies, investment banks, insurance companies, and other financial institutions. Banking in Oregon and Washington is dominated by several large banking institutions including U.S. Bank, Wells Fargo Bank, Bank of America, Key Bank and Chase. Together these banks account for a majority of the total commercial and savings bank deposits in Oregon and Washington. These competitors have significantly greater financial resources and offer a much greater number of branch locations. The Company offsets the advantage of the larger competitors by focusing on certain market segments, providing high levels of customization and personal service, and tailoring its technology, products and services to the specific market segments that the Company serves.

In addition to larger institutions, numerous “community” banks and credit unions operated, expanded or moved into the Company’s three primary markets and have developed a similar focus to that of the Company. These institutions have further increased competition in all three of the Company’s primary markets. This number of similar financial institutions and an increased focus by larger institutions in the Company’s primary markets has led to intensified competition in all aspects of the Company’s business, particularly in the area of loan and deposit pricing.

The adoption of the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 (the “GLB Act”) led to further intensification of competition in the financial services industry. The GLB Act eliminated many of the barriers to affiliation among providers of various types of financial services and has permitted business combinations among financial service providers such as banks, insurance companies, securities or brokerage firms and other financial service providers. Additionally, the rapid adoption of financial services through the Internet has reduced or even eliminated many barriers to entry by financial service providers physically located outside our market areas. For example, remote deposit services allow depository companies physically located in other geographical markets to service local businesses with minimal cost of entry. Although the Company has been able to compete effectively in the financial services business in its markets to date, it may not be able to continue to do so in the future.

The financial services industry has experienced widespread consolidation over the last decade. Between 2009 and 2011, 23 banks in Oregon and Washington were closed by the regulators; however only one regulatory closure occurred in the last three years. Beginning in 2012, consolidation continued in the form of bank acquisitions throughout the Northwest. The Company anticipates consolidation among financial institutions in its market areas will continue. In addition, with the passage of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), smaller financial institutions may find it difficult to continue to operate due to higher anticipated regulatory costs. This may create pressure on these institutions to seek partnerships or mergers with larger companies. The Company seeks acquisition opportunities from time-to-time, including FDIC-assisted transactions, in its existing markets and in new markets of strategic importance. However, other financial institutions aggressively compete against the Company in the acquisition market. Some of these institutions may have greater access to capital markets, larger cash reserves, and stock that is more liquid and more highly valued by the market for use in acquisitions. The Dodd-Frank Act also authorized nationwide de novo branching by national and state banks and certain foreign banks operating in the U.S., which could also result in new entrants to the markets served by the Bank.

In addition, the Company anticipates more competitive pressure for new loans in its markets. While the Bank’s loan demand has improved throughout 2014, healthy banks with ample capital and liquidity are expected to aggressively seek new loan customers. This may cause pressure on loan pricing and make it more difficult to retain existing loan customers or attract new ones and may create compression in the Company’s net interest margin.

 

7


Table of Contents

Services Provided

The Company offers a wide array of financial service products to meet the banking needs of its targeted segments in the market areas served. The Company regularly reviews the profitability and desirability of various product offerings, particularly new product offerings, to assure ongoing viability.

Deposit Services

The Company offers a wide range of deposit services that are typically available in most banks and other financial institutions including checking, savings, money market accounts and time deposits. The transaction accounts and time deposits are tailored to the Company’s primary markets and market segments at rates competitive with those offered in the area. Additional deposits are generated through national networks for institutional deposits. All deposit accounts are insured by the FDIC to the maximum amount permitted by law, currently $250,000 per depositor. The Company provides online cash management, remote deposit capture and banking services to businesses and consumers. The Company also allows 24-hour customer access to deposit and loan information via telephone and online cash management products.

Lending Activities

The Company emphasizes specific areas of lending within its primary markets. Commercial loans are made primarily to professionals, community-based businesses and nonprofit organizations. These loans are available for general operating purposes, acquisition of fixed assets, purchases of equipment and machinery, financing of inventory and accounts receivable and other business purposes. The Company also originates U.S. Small Business Administration (“SBA”) loans and is a national SBA preferred lender.

Within its primary markets, the Company also originates permanent and construction loans financing commercial facilities and pre-sold, custom and speculative home construction. The major thrust of residential construction lending is smaller in-fill construction projects consisting of single-family residences. However, due to the rapid deterioration in the national and regional housing market, the Company severely restricted lending on speculative home construction and significantly reduced its exposure to residential construction lending in 2009. At the same time, due to the economic recession and softness in commercial real estate markets, the Company took steps to reduce its exposure to commercial real estate loans both for construction of new facilities and permanent loans for commercial facilities, particularly investor-owned facilities. During 2014, as commercial real estate prices continued to stabilize or improved, the Company expanded construction financing activity in commercial real estate and multifamily residential construction financing.

Due to the Company’s concentration in real estate secured loans, the Company strategically focuses on increasing its commercial and industrial (“C & I”) loan lending. In particular, the Company has developed a specialty in C & I lending to dental professionals. Loans to dental professionals include loans for such purposes as starting up a practice, acquisition of a practice, equipment financing, owner-occupied facilities, and working capital. Loans for dental office startups are typically SBA loans as these loans represent additional risk. During 2014, the Company expanded its national dental lending program and now has $306,391 in active loans in 35 states. During 2014, national lending was limited to loans to dental professionals for acquisition of practices by experienced dental professionals, owner-occupied commercial real estate or seasoned practice refinance loans.

The Company makes secured and unsecured loans to individuals for various purposes, including purchases of automobiles, mobile homes, boats, and other recreational vehicles, home improvements, education, and personal investment.

Inter-agency guidelines adopted by federal bank regulators mandate that financial institutions establish real estate lending policies with maximum allowable real estate loan-to-value limits, subject to an allowable amount of non-conforming loans as a percentage of capital. The Board of Directors has approved specific lending policies and procedures for the Company, and management is responsible for implementation of these policies. The lending policies and procedures include guidelines for loan term, loan-to-value ratios that are within established federal banking guidelines, collateral appraisals, and cash flow coverage. The loan policies also vest varying levels of loan authority in management, the Company’s Loan Committee and the Board of Directors. Company management monitors lending activities through management meetings, loan committee meetings, monthly reporting, and periodic review of loans by third-party contractors.

 

8


Table of Contents

Merchant and Card Services

In December 2013, the Company entered into an agreement with Vantiv, a third-party provider of merchant services, to outsource all merchant processing for the Bank’s clients. The agreement provides for a portion of the revenue generated from existing and new clients to be shared with the Company. Through the agreement, the Company’s existing merchant portfolio was converted onto the Vantiv platform. In addition, the customer service function is performed by Vantiv, which resulted in full-time equivalent (“FTE”) employee savings for the Bank.

Other Services

The Company provides other traditional commercial and consumer banking services, including cash management products for businesses, online banking, safe deposit services, debit and automated teller machine (“ATM”) cards, automated clearing house (“ACH”) transactions, cashier’s checks, notary services and others. The Company is a member of numerous ATM networks and utilizes an outside processor for the processing of these automated transactions. The Company has an agreement with MoneyPass, an ATM provider, which permits Company customers to use MoneyPass ATMs located throughout the country at no charge to the customer.

Employees

At December 31, 2014, the Company employed 291 FTE employees with 22 FTE employees in the Seattle market, 53 FTE employees in the Portland market, and 76 FTE employees in the Eugene market as well as 140 FTE employees in administrative functions primarily located in Eugene, Oregon. None of these employees is represented by labor unions, and management believes that the Company’s relationship with its employees is good. The Company emphasizes a positive work environment for its employees, which is validated by recognition from independent third-parties.

During 2014, the Company was recognized for the fifteenth consecutive year by Oregon Business magazine as one of the 100 Best Companies to Work For in Oregon. Also, the Company was recognized by Seattle Business magazine as one of Washington’s “100 Best Companies to Work For.” Additionally, Portland Business Journal named the Company as one of Oregon’s most admired companies. This was the sixth time the Company was recognized as a top-ten company in the “Financial Services” classification. On October 21, 2014, the Company was recognized at the national American Bankers Association conference as the National Community Commitment Award winner for the Company’s commitment to employee volunteerism.

Management continually strives to retain and attract top talent as well as provide career development opportunities to enhance skill levels. A number of benefit programs are available to eligible employees, including group medical plans, paid sick leave, paid vacation, group life insurance, 401(k) plans, deferred compensation plans, and equity compensation plans.

Supervision and Regulation

General

The following discussion provides an overview of certain elements of the extensive bank regulatory framework applicable to the Company and the Bank. This regulatory framework is primarily designed for the protection of depositors and other customers of banks, the federal deposit insurance fund and the banking system as a whole, rather than specifically for the protection of shareholders or other investors in the securities of banking organizations in the United States. Due to the breadth and growth of this regulatory framework, our costs of compliance continue to increase in order to monitor and satisfy these requirements.

To the extent that this section describes statutory and regulatory provisions, it is qualified by reference to those provisions. These statutes and regulations, as well as related policies, are subject to change by Congress, state legislatures and federal and state regulators. Changes in statutes, regulations or regulatory policies applicable to us, including the interpretation or implementation thereof, could have a material adverse effect on our business and operations. In light of the financial crisis, which began in 2008 and 2009, numerous changes to the statutes, regulations or regulatory policies applicable to the Company and other banks generally have been made or proposed. The full extent to which these changes will impact our business is not yet known. However, our continued efforts to monitor and comply with new regulatory requirements add to the complexity and cost of our business.

 

9


Table of Contents

Federal and State Bank Holding Company Regulation

General. The Company is a bank holding company as defined in the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (“BHCA”), and is therefore subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the Federal Reserve. In general, the BHCA limits the business of bank holding companies to owning or controlling banks and engaging in other activities closely related to banking. The Company must file reports with and provide to the Federal Reserve such additional information as it may require. Under the GLB Act, a bank holding company may apply to the Federal Reserve to become a financial holding company, and thereby engage (directly or through a subsidiary) in certain expanded activities deemed financial in nature, such as securities and insurance underwriting. The Company has not applied to the Federal Reserve to become a financial holding company and has no plans to do so.

Holding Company Bank Ownership. The BHCA requires every bank holding company to obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve before (i) acquiring, directly or indirectly, ownership or control of any voting shares of another bank or bank holding company if, after such acquisition, it would own or control more than 5 percent of such shares; (ii) acquiring all or substantially all of the assets of another bank or bank holding company; or (iii) merging or consolidating with another bank holding company.

Holding Company Control of Non-Banks. With some exceptions, the BHCA also prohibits a bank holding company from acquiring or retaining direct or indirect ownership or control of more than 5 percent of the voting shares of any company which is not a bank or bank holding company, or from engaging directly or indirectly in activities other than those of banking, managing or controlling banks, or providing services for its subsidiaries. The principal exceptions to these prohibitions involve certain non-bank activities that, by statute or by Federal Reserve regulation or order, have been identified as activities closely related to the business of banking or of managing or controlling banks.

Transactions with Affiliates. Subsidiary banks of a bank holding company are subject to restrictions imposed by the Federal Reserve Act on extensions of credit to the holding company or its subsidiaries, on investments in their securities, and on the use of their securities as collateral for loans to any borrower. These restrictions prevent the Company from borrowing from the Bank unless the loans are secured by marketable obligations of designated amounts. Further, such secured loans and investments by the Bank to or in the Company are limited individually to 10 percent of the Bank’s capital stock and surplus and in the aggregate to 20 percent of the Bank’s capital stock and surplus. The Federal Reserve Act also provides that extensions of credit and other transactions between the Bank and the Company must be on terms and conditions, including credit standards, that are substantially the same or at least as favorable to the Bank as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions involving other non-affiliated companies, or, in the absence of comparable transactions, on terms and conditions, including credit standards, that in good faith would be offered to, or would apply to, non-affiliated companies. These regulations and restrictions may limit the Company’s ability to obtain funds from the Bank for its cash needs, including funds for payment of dividends, interest and operational expenses.

Tying Arrangements. The Company is prohibited from engaging in certain tie-in arrangements in connection with any extension of credit, sale or lease of property or furnishing of services. For example, with certain exceptions, neither the Company nor its subsidiaries may condition an extension of credit to a customer on either (i) a requirement that the customer obtain additional services provided by us; or (ii) an agreement by the customer to refrain from obtaining other services from a competitor.

Support of Subsidiary Banks. Under Federal Reserve policy and the Dodd-Frank Act, the Company is required to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to the Bank. This means that the Company is required to commit, as necessary, resources to support the Bank. However, the contribution of additional capital to an under-capitalized subsidiary bank may be required at times when a bank holding company may not have the resources to provide such support. Any capital loans a bank holding company makes to its subsidiary banks are subordinate to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of those subsidiary banks.

State Law Restrictions. As an Oregon corporation, the Company is subject to certain limitations and restrictions under applicable Oregon corporate law. For example, state law restrictions and limitations in Oregon include indemnification of directors, distributions to shareholders, transactions involving directors, officers or interested shareholders, maintenance of books, records and minutes, and observance of certain corporate formalities.

 

10


Table of Contents

Federal and State Regulation of Pacific Continental Bank

General. The Bank is an Oregon commercial bank operating in Oregon and Washington with deposits insured by the FDIC. As an Oregon state bank that is not a member of the Federal Reserve System, the Bank is subject to supervision and regulation by the Oregon Department of Consumer and Business Services (the “Oregon Department”) and the FDIC. These agencies have the authority to prohibit banks from engaging in what they believe constitute unsafe or unsound banking practices. Additionally, the Bank’s branches in Washington are subject to supervision and regulation by the Washington Department of Financial Institutions and must comply with applicable Washington laws regarding community reinvestment, consumer protection, fair lending, and intrastate branching.

Consumer Protection. The Bank is subject to a variety of federal and state consumer protection laws and regulations that govern its relationship with consumers, including laws and regulations that mandate certain disclosure requirements and regulate the manner in which we take deposits, make and collect loans, and provide other services. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations can subject the Bank to various penalties, including but not limited to, enforcement actions, injunctions, fines, civil liability, criminal penalties, punitive damages, and the loss of certain contractual rights.

Community Reinvestment. The Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 (“CRA”) requires that, in connection with examinations of financial institutions within their jurisdiction, the FDIC evaluate the record of the financial institution in meeting the credit needs of its local communities, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods, consistent with the safe and sound operation of the institution. In addition to substantial penalties and corrective measures that may be required for a violation of certain fair lending laws, the federal banking agencies may take compliance with such laws and the CRA into account when regulating and supervising other activities, and in evaluating whether to approve applications for permission to engage in new activities or for acquisitions of other banks or companies or de novo branching. An unsatisfactory CRA rating may be the basis for denying the application. In the most current CRA examination report dated February 24, 2014, the Bank’s compliance with CRA was rated “Satisfactory”.

Insider Credit Transactions. Banks are also subject to certain restrictions imposed by the Federal Reserve Act and the regulations of the Federal Reserve on extensions of credit to executive officers, directors, principal shareholders or any related interests of such persons. Extensions of credit (i) must be made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, and follow credit underwriting procedures that are at least as stringent as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with persons not covered above and who are not employees; and (ii) must not involve more than the normal risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features. Banks are also subject to certain lending limits and restrictions on overdrafts to insiders. A violation of these restrictions may result in the assessment of substantial civil monetary penalties, regulatory enforcement actions, and other regulatory sanctions.

Regulation of Management. Federal law (i) sets forth circumstances under which officers or directors of a bank may be removed by the institution’s federal supervisory agency; (ii) places restraints on lending by a bank to its executive officers, directors, principal shareholders and their related interests; and (iii) generally prohibits management personnel of a bank from serving as a director or in other management positions of another financial institution whose assets exceed a specified amount or which has an office within a specified geographic area.

Safety and Soundness Standards. Certain non-capital safety and soundness standards are also imposed upon banks. These standards cover internal controls, information systems and internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth, compensation, fees and benefits, such other operational and managerial standards as the agency determines to be appropriate, and standards for asset quality, earnings and stock valuation. An institution that fails to meet these standards may be subject to regulatory sanctions.

Customer Information Security. The federal bank regulatory agencies have adopted guidelines for safeguarding confidential, personal customer information. The guidelines require each financial institution to create, implement and maintain a comprehensive written information security program designed to ensure the security and confidentiality of customer information, protect against any anticipated threats or hazards to the security or integrity of such information and protect against unauthorized access to or use of such information that could result in substantial harm or inconvenience to any customer. The Bank has adopted a customer information security program.

Privacy. The GLB Act requires financial institutions to implement policies and procedures regarding the disclosure of nonpublic personal information about consumers to non-affiliated third parties. In general, the statute requires explanations to consumers on policies and procedures regarding the disclosure of such nonpublic personal information, and, except as

 

11


Table of Contents

otherwise required by law, prohibits disclosing such information except as provided in the banks’ policies and procedures. The Bank implemented a privacy policy, which provides that all of its existing and new customers will be notified of the Bank’s privacy policies. State laws and regulations designed to protect the privacy and security of customer information also apply to us.

Interstate Banking and Branching

The Riegle-Neal Interstate Banking and Branching Efficiency Act of 1994 (“Interstate Act”), together with the Dodd-Frank Act, relaxed prior interstate branching restrictions under federal law by permitting, subject to regulatory approval, state and federally chartered commercial banks to establish branches in states where the laws permit banks chartered in such states to establish branches. The Interstate Act requires regulators to consult with community organizations before permitting an interstate institution to close a branch in a low-income area. Federal banking agency regulations prohibit banks from using their interstate branches primarily for deposit production, and the federal banking agencies have implemented a loan-to-deposit ratio screen to ensure compliance with this prohibition. The Dodd-Frank Act also authorized nationwide de novo branching by national and state banks and certain foreign banks operating in the U.S., which could also result in new entrants to the markets served by the Bank.

Dividends

The principal source of the Company’s cash is from dividends received from the Bank, which are subject to government regulation and limitations. In addition, capital raises may provide another source of cash. Regulatory authorities may prohibit banks and bank holding companies from paying dividends in a manner that would constitute an unsafe or unsound banking practice or would reduce the amount of its capital below that necessary to meet minimum applicable regulatory capital requirements. The Oregon Bank Act and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 also limit a bank’s ability to pay cash dividends to its parent company. A bank may not pay cash dividends if that payment would reduce the amount of its capital below that necessary to meet minimum applicable regulatory capital requirements. In addition, under the Oregon Bank Act, the amount of the dividend paid by the Bank may not be greater than net unreserved retained earnings, after first deducting, to the extent not already charged against earnings or reflected in a reserve, all bad debts, which are debts on which interest is unpaid and past due at least six months unless the debt is fully secured and in the process of collection; all other assets charged-off as required by Oregon bank regulators or a state or federal examiner; and all accrued expenses, interest and taxes of the Bank. The Federal Reserve has issued a policy statement on the payment of cash dividends by bank holding companies, which expresses the Federal Reserve’s view that a bank holding company should pay cash dividends only to the extent that its net income for the past year is sufficient to cover both the cash dividends and a rate of earnings retention that is consistent with the holding company’s capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition. Payment of cash dividends by the Company and the Bank will depend on sufficient earnings to support them and adherence to bank regulatory requirements.

Capital Adequacy

Regulatory Capital Guidelines. Federal bank regulatory agencies use capital adequacy guidelines in the examination and regulation of bank holding companies and banks. The guidelines are “risk-based,” meaning that they are designed to make capital requirements more sensitive to differences in risk profiles among banks and bank holding companies.

Tier 1 and Tier 2 Capital. Under the guidelines, an institution’s capital is divided into two broad categories, Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital. Tier 1 capital generally consists of common stockholders’ equity (including surplus and undivided profits), qualifying non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, and qualified minority interests in the equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries. Tier 2 capital generally consists of the allowance for loan losses, hybrid capital instruments, and qualifying subordinated debt. The sum of Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital represents an institution’s total capital. The guidelines require that at least 50 percent of an institution’s total capital consist of Tier 1 capital.

Risk-based Capital Ratios. The adequacy of an institution’s capital is gauged primarily with reference to the institution’s risk-weighted assets. The guidelines assign risk weightings to an institution’s assets in an effort to quantify the relative risk of each asset and to determine the minimum capital required to support that risk. An institution’s risk-weighted assets are then compared with its Tier 1 capital and total capital to arrive at a Tier 1 risk-based ratio and a total risk-based ratio, respectively. The guidelines provide that an institution must have a minimum Tier 1 risk-based ratio of 4 percent and a minimum total risk-based ratio of 8 percent.

 

12


Table of Contents

Leverage Ratio. The guidelines also employ a leverage ratio, which is Tier 1 capital as a percentage of average total assets, less goodwill and intangible assets. The principal objective of the leverage ratio is to constrain the maximum degree to which an institution may leverage its equity capital base. The minimum leverage ratio is 3 percent; however, for all but the most highly rated institutions and for institutions seeking to expand, regulators expect an additional cushion of at least 1 percent to 2 percent.

Prompt Corrective Action. Under the guidelines, an institution is assigned to one of five capital categories depending on its total risk-based capital ratio, Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio, and leverage ratio, together with certain subjective factors. The categories range from “well-capitalized” to “critically under-capitalized.” Institutions that are “under-capitalized” or lower are subject to certain mandatory supervisory corrective actions. At each successively lower capital category, an insured bank is subject to increased restrictions on its operations. Failure to meet regulatory capital guidelines can result in a bank being required to raise additional capital. An “under-capitalized” bank must develop a capital restoration plan and its parent holding company must guarantee compliance with the plan subject to certain limits. During these challenging economic times, the federal banking regulators have actively enforced these provisions.

At December 31, 2014, the Company and the Bank each exceeded the required risk-based capital ratios for classification as “well capitalized” as well as the required minimum leverage ratios for the Bank. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Capital Resources” in this Form 10-K.

Regulatory Capital Framework; Recent Rule-Making by U.S. Bank Regulatory Agencies. Until recently, the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies’ risk-based capital guidelines were based upon the 1988 capital accord (“Basel I”) of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (the “Basel Committee”). The Basel Committee is a committee of banking supervisory authorities from major countries in the global financial system which formulates broad supervisory standards and guidelines relating to financial institutions for implementation on a country-by-country basis.

In July 2013, the Federal Reserve Board and the other U.S. federal banking agencies adopted final rules making significant changes to the U.S. regulatory capital framework for U.S. banking organizations and to conform this framework to the Basel Committee’s current international regulatory capital accord (“Basel III”). These rules replace the U.S. federal banking agencies’ general risk-based capital rules, advanced approaches rule, market-risk rule, and leverage rules, in accordance with certain transition provisions. Banks, such as Pacific Continental Bank, became subject to the new rules on January 1, 2015. The new rules establish more restrictive capital definitions, create additional categories and higher risk-weightings for certain asset classes and off-balance sheet exposures, higher leverage ratios and capital conservation buffers that will be added to the minimum capital requirements and must be met for banking organizations to avoid being subject to certain limitations on dividends and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers. The new rules also implement higher minimum capital requirements, include a new common equity Tier 1 capital requirement, and establish criteria that instruments must meet in order to be considered common equity Tier 1 capital, additional Tier 1 capital, or Tier 2 capital. When fully phased in, the final rules will provide for increased minimum capital ratios as follows: (a) a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 4.50%; (b) a Tier 1 capital ratio of 6.00% (which is an increase from 4.00%); (c) a total capital ratio of 8.00%; and (d) a Tier 1 leverage ratio to average consolidated assets of 4.00%. While earlier proposals would have required that trust preferred securities be phased out of Tier 1 capital, the new rules exempt depository institution holding companies with less than $15 billion in total consolidated assets as of December 31, 2009, such as the Company, from this requirement. These capital instruments, if issued prior to May 19, 2010, and currently in Tier 1 capital, are grandfathered in Tier 1 capital, subject to certain limits. Under the new rules, in order to avoid limitations on capital distributions, including dividend payments and certain discretionary bonus payments to executive officers, a banking organization must hold a capital conservation buffer composed of common equity Tier 1 capital above its minimum risk-based capital requirements (equal to 2.50% of total risk-weighted assets). The phase-in of the capital conservation buffer will begin January 1, 2016, and be completed by January 1, 2019. The new rules also provide for various adjustments and deductions to the definitions of regulatory capital that will phase in from January 1, 2014 to December 31, 2017. In January 2014, the Basel Committee issued its nearly final version of its leverage ratio and disclosure guidance (the “Basel III Leverage Ratio”). The Basel III Leverage Ratio will be subject to further calibration until 2017, with final implementation expected by January 2018. The Basel III Leverage Ratio makes a number of significant changes to the Basel Committee’s June 2013 consultative paper by easing the approach to measuring the exposures of off-balance sheet items. These changes address the financial services industry’s concern that the consultative paper’s definition of exposure was too expansive, i.e., that the leverage ratio’s denominator was too large. The implementation of these new rules could have an adverse impact on our financial position and future earnings due to the inclusion of Tier 1 capital as a core capital component and because of the heightened minimum capital requirements. The newly adopted capital rules could restrict our ability to grow during favorable market conditions, or require us to raise additional capital and liquidity, generally increase our cost of doing business, and impose other restrictions on our operations.

 

13


Table of Contents

The application of more stringent capital requirements would, among other things, result in lower returns on invested capital and result in regulatory sanctions if we were unable to comply with these requirements. As a result, our business, results of operations, financial condition or prospects could be adversely affected. We are currently evaluating the impact of the new capital rules on our regulatory capital position; however, we expect that we will be able to satisfy the minimum capital requirements adopted by the Federal Reserve and the other U.S. banking agencies within the prescribed implementation timelines. For additional information, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Capital Resources” in this Form 10-K.

Regulatory Oversight and Examination

The Federal Reserve conducts periodic inspections of bank holding companies, which are performed both onsite and offsite. The supervisory objectives of the inspection program are to ascertain whether the financial strength of the bank holding company is being maintained on an ongoing basis and to determine the effects or consequences of transactions between a holding company or its non-banking subsidiaries and its subsidiary banks. For holding companies under $10 billion in assets, such as the Company, the inspection type and frequency varies depending on asset size, complexity of the organization and the holding company’s rating at its last inspection.

The Federal Reserve Board also has extensive enforcement authority over all bank holding companies, such as the Company. Such enforcement powers include the power to assess civil money penalties against any bank holding company violating any provision of the BHCA or any regulation or order of the Federal Reserve Board under the BHCA and the power to order termination of activities or ownership of nonbank subsidiaries of the holding company if it determines that there is reasonable cause to believe that the activities or ownership of the non-bank subsidiaries constitutes a serious risk to the financial safety, soundness or stability of banks owned by the bank holding company. Knowing violations of the BHCA or regulations or orders of the Federal Reserve Board can also result in criminal penalties for the company and any individuals participating in such conduct.

Banks are subject to periodic examinations by their primary regulators. Bank examinations have evolved from reliance on transaction testing in assessing a bank’s condition to a risk-focused approach. These examinations are extensive and cover the entire breadth of operations of the Bank. Generally, safety and soundness examinations occur on an 18-month cycle for banks under $500 million in total assets that are well-capitalized and without regulatory issues, and on a 12-month cycle otherwise. Examinations alternate between the federal and state bank regulatory agency and may occur on a combined schedule. The frequency of consumer compliance and CRA examinations is linked to the size of the institution and its compliance and CRA ratings at its most recent examinations. However, the examination authority of the FDIC allows it to examine supervised banks as frequently as deemed necessary based on the condition of the Bank or as a result of certain triggering events. Neither the Company nor the Bank is party to a formal or informal agreement with the FDIC, the Federal Reserve or the Oregon Department of Consumer and Business Services.

Corporate Governance and Accounting

Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (the “Act”) addresses, among other things, corporate governance, auditing and accounting, enhanced and timely disclosure of corporate information, and penalties for non-compliance. Generally, the Act (i) requires chief executive officers and chief financial officers to certify to the accuracy of periodic reports filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”), (ii) imposes specific and enhanced corporate disclosure requirements, (iii) accelerates the time frame for reporting of insider transactions and periodic disclosures by public companies, (iv) requires companies to adopt and disclose information about corporate governance practices, including whether or not they have adopted a code of ethics for senior financial officers and whether the audit committee includes at least one “audit committee financial expert,” and (v) requires the SEC, based on certain enumerated factors, to regularly and systematically review corporate filings.

As a publicly reporting company, we are subject to the requirements of the Act and related rules and regulations issued by the SEC and NASDAQ. After enactment, we updated our policies and procedures to comply with the Act’s requirements and have found that such compliance, including compliance with Section 404 of the Act relating to internal control over financial reporting, has resulted in significant additional expense for the Company. We anticipate that we will continue to incur such additional expense in our ongoing compliance.

 

14


Table of Contents

Anti-terrorism and Anti-Money Laundering

USA Patriot Act of 2001. The Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001, intended to combat terrorism, was renewed with certain amendments in 2006 (the “Patriot Act”). Certain provisions of the Patriot Act were made permanent and other sections were made subject to extended “sunset” provisions. The Patriot Act, in relevant part, (i) prohibits banks from providing correspondent accounts directly to foreign shell banks; (ii) imposes due diligence requirements on banks opening or holding accounts for foreign financial institutions or wealthy foreign individuals; (iii) requires financial institutions to establish an anti-money laundering compliance program; and (iv) eliminates civil liability for persons who file suspicious activity reports.

In recent years, the federal bank regulators have announced regulatory enforcement actions against a number of large bank holding companies and banks arising from deficiencies in processes, procedures and controls involving anti-money laundering measures and compliance with the economic sanctions that affect transactions with designated foreign countries, nationals and others as provided for in the regulations of the Office of Foreign Assets Control of the U.S. Treasury Department. These actions evidence an intensification of the U.S. government’s expectations for compliance with these regulatory regimes on the part of banks operating in the U.S., including the Bank, and may result in increased compliance costs and increased risks of regulatory sanctions.

Financial Services Modernization

The GLB Act, which became law in 1999, brought about significant changes to the laws affecting banks and bank holding companies. Generally, the GLB Act (i) repeals historical restrictions on preventing banks from affiliating with securities firms; (ii) provides a uniform framework for the activities of banks, savings institutions and their holding companies; (iii) broadens the activities that may be conducted by national banks and banking subsidiaries of bank holding companies; (iv) provides an enhanced framework for protecting the privacy of consumer information and requires notification to consumers of bank privacy policies; and (v) addresses a variety of other legal and regulatory issues affecting both day-to-day operations and long-term activities of financial institutions. Bank holding companies that qualify and elect to become financial holding companies can engage in a wider variety of financial activities than permitted under previous law, particularly with respect to insurance and securities underwriting activities.

Deposit Insurance

The Bank’s deposits are insured under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, up to the maximum applicable limits, and are subject to deposit insurance assessments designed to tie what banks pay for deposit insurance more closely to the risks they pose. The Dodd-Frank Act required the FDIC to amend its regulations to redefine the assessment base used for calculating deposit insurance assessments. As a result, assessments are now based on a financial institution’s average consolidated total assets less average tangible equity. The rules revised the assessment rate schedule and adopted additional rate schedules that will go into effect when the Deposit Insurance Fund reserve ratio reaches various milestones. The Dodd-Frank Act required the FDIC to increase the reserve ratio of the Deposit Insurance Fund from 1.15 percent to 1.35 percent of insured deposits by 2020 and eliminated the requirement that the FDIC pay dividends to insured depository institutions when the reserve ratio exceeds certain thresholds. In October 2010, the FDIC adopted a comprehensive, long-range “restoration” plan for the Deposit Insurance Fund to ensure that the ratio of the fund’s reserves to insured deposits reaches 1.35 percent by 2020, as required by the Dodd-Frank Act. The fund’s designated reserve ratio for 2015 was set at 2.0 percent. The final rule adopts progressively lower assessment rate schedules as the fund reaches specified reserve levels. There can be no assurance that the FDIC will not impose special assessments or increase annual assessments in the future.

The FDIC may terminate the deposit insurance of any insured depository institution if it determines that the institution has engaged in or is engaging in unsafe and unsound banking practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition or has violated any applicable law, regulation or order or any condition imposed in writing by, or pursuant to, any written agreement with the FDIC. The termination of deposit insurance for the Bank could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations due to the fact that the Bank’s liquidity position would likely be adversely affected by deposit withdrawal activity.

The Federal Deposit Insurance Act provides that, in the event of the liquidation or other resolution of an insured depository institution, the claims of its depositors (including claims by the FDIC as subrogee of insured depositors) and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as receiver would be afforded a priority over other general unsecured claims against such an institution. If an insured depository institution fails, insured and uninsured depositors along with the FDIC will be placed ahead of unsecured, non-deposit creditors, in order of priority of payment.

 

15


Table of Contents

If any insured depository institution becomes insolvent and the FDIC is appointed its conservator or receiver, the FDIC may, in most cases, disaffirm or repudiate any contract to which such institution is a party, if the FDIC determines that performance of the contract would be burdensome, and that disaffirmance or repudiation of the contract would promote the orderly administration of the institution’s affairs. In addition, the FDIC as conservator or receiver may enforce most contracts entered into by the institution notwithstanding any provision providing for termination, default, acceleration or exercise of rights upon or solely by reason of insolvency of the institution, appointment of a conservator or receiver for the institution, or exercise of rights or powers by a conservator or receiver for the institution.

Other Legislation

Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act. As a result of the financial crises beginning in 2008-2009, on July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law. The Dodd-Frank Act has had, and is expected to continue to have, a broad impact on the financial services industry, including significant regulatory and compliance changes and changes to corporate governance matters affecting public companies. Among other provisions, the Dodd-Frank Act (1) created the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau with broad powers to regulate consumer financial products such as credit cards and mortgages, (2) created the Financial Stability Oversight Council (comprised of the Secretary of the Treasury, heads of the federal bank regulatory agencies and the SEC, and certain other officials) to provide oversight of all risks created within the U.S. economy from the activities of financial services companies, (3) has led to new capital requirements from federal banking agencies, (4) placed new limits on electronic debit card interchange fees, and (5) required the SEC and national stock exchanges to adopt significant new corporate governance and executive compensation reforms. As discussed below, various of the law’s provisions have been implemented by rules and regulations of the federal banking agencies, but certain provisions of the law are yet to be implemented. As a result, the full scope and impact of the law on banking institutions generally and on our business and operations cannot be fully determined at this time. However, the Dodd-Frank Act is expected to have a significant impact on our business operations, including increasing the cost of doing business, as its provisions continue to take effect. Some of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act that may impact our business are summarized below.

Corporate Governance. The Dodd-Frank Act requires publicly traded companies to provide their shareholders with (1) a non-binding shareholder vote on executive compensation, (2) a non-binding shareholder vote on the frequency of such vote, (3) disclosure of “golden parachute” arrangements in connection with specified change in control transactions, and (4) a non-binding shareholder vote on golden parachute arrangements in connection with these change in control transactions. Except with respect to “smaller reporting companies” and participants in the Troubled Asset Relief Program (“TARP”), the new rules applied to proxy statements relating to annual meetings of shareholders to be held after January 20, 2011.

Prohibition Against Charter Conversions of Troubled Institutions. The Dodd-Frank Act generally prohibits a depository institution from converting from a state to federal charter, or vice versa, while subject to an enforcement action, unless the bank seeks prior approval from its regulator and complies with specified procedures to ensure compliance with the enforcement action.

Overdraft and Interchange Fees. In November 2009, the Federal Reserve adopted amendments under its Regulation E that imposed new restrictions on banks’ abilities to charge overdraft services and fees. The rule prohibits financial institutions from charging fees for paying overdrafts on ATM and one-time debit card transactions, unless a consumer consents, or opts in, to the overdraft service for those types of transactions. The opt-in provision established requirements for clear disclosure of fees and terms of overdraft services for ATM and one-time debit card transactions. Since a percentage of the Bank’s service charges on deposits are in the form of overdraft fees on point-of-sale transactions, this has had an adverse impact on our noninterest income.

The Dodd-Frank Act, through a provision known as the Durbin Amendment, required the Federal Reserve to establish standards for interchange fees that are “reasonable and proportional” to the cost of processing the debit card transaction and imposes other requirements on card networks. Under the final rule, effective in October 2011, the maximum permissible interchange fee that a bank may receive is the sum of $0.21 per transaction and five basis points multiplied by the value of the transaction, with an additional upward adjustment of no more than $0.01 per transaction if a bank develops and implements policies and procedures reasonably designed to achieve fraud-prevention standards set by regulation. In July 2013, in an action brought by a retailer trade association, a Federal district court held that this regulation was not valid under the Act’s standard that the fee be “reasonable and proportional” to the cost of processing the debit card transaction and

 

16


Table of Contents

improperly included certain categories of costs in applying the statutory standard. In March 2014, a panel of the U.S. Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit reversed the district court’s ruling almost in its entirety, concluding that the Federal Reserve had reasonably interpreted the statute to allow card issuers to recover certain costs that are incremental to costs incurred in the authorization, clearance and settlement of debit card transactions. The retailer trade association appealed the decision, to U.S. Supreme Court. On January 20, 2015, the U.S. Supreme Court denied the trade association appeal. The Supreme Court action leaves in place the Federal Reserve’s regulation on charges for overdraft services and interchange fees on debit card transactions, reducing the fee revenues that banks receive from the business of processing debit card transactions. While the restrictions on interchange fees do not apply to banks that, together with their affiliates, have assets of less than $10 billion, the rule could affect the competitiveness of debit cards issued by smaller banks.

Consumer Financial Protection Bureau. The Dodd-Frank Act created a new, independent federal agency called the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (“CFPB”). The CFPB has broad rulemaking, supervision and enforcement authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws for banks and thrifts with greater than $10 billion in assets. Among the CFPB’s responsibilities are implementing and enforcing federal consumer financial protection laws, reviewing the business practices of financial services providers for legal compliance, monitoring the marketplace for transparency on behalf of consumers and receiving complaints and questions from consumers about consumer financial products and services. The Dodd-Frank Act added prohibitions on unfair, deceptive or abusive acts and practices to the scope of consumer protection regulations overseen and enforced by the CFPB. Institutions with less than $10 billion in assets, such as the Company, are subject to rules promulgated by the CFPB but will continue to be examined and supervised by their federal banking regulators for compliance purposes.

Repeal of Demand Deposit Interest Prohibition. The Dodd-Frank Act repealed the federal prohibitions on the payment of interest on demand deposits, thereby permitting depository institutions to pay interest on business transaction and other accounts.

Proposed Legislation

Proposed legislation that may affect the Company and the Bank is introduced in almost every legislative session, both federal and state. Certain of such legislation could dramatically affect the regulation of the banking industry and significantly change the competitive and operating environment in which we operate. We cannot predict if any such legislation will be adopted or, if it is adopted, how it would affect the business of the Bank or the Company. Past history has demonstrated that new legislation or changes to existing laws or regulations usually results in a greater compliance burden and therefore generally increases our cost of doing business.

Effects of Government Monetary Policy

Our earnings and growth are affected not only by general economic conditions, but also by the fiscal and monetary policies of the federal government, particularly the Federal Reserve. The Federal Reserve implements national monetary policy for such purposes as curbing inflation and combating recession. Its open market operations in U.S. government securities, control of the discount rate applicable to borrowings from the Federal Reserve, and establishment of reserve requirements against certain deposits, influence the growth of bank loans, investments and deposits, and also affect interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits. For the past several years, the banking industry has been operating in an extremely low interest rate environment relative to historical averages, and the Federal Reserve has pursued highly accommodative monetary measures, including a very low federal funds rate and substantial purchases of long-term U.S. Treasury and agency securities in an effort to facilitate growth in the U.S. economy and a reduction in levels of unemployment. During 2014, the Federal Reserve began to gradually ease its accommodative monetary policies including discontinuing its asset purchase program in October 2014. However, the Federal Reserve further indicated that it expects to maintain the current very low target range for the federal funds rate for some time while it assesses progress towards its objectives of maximum employment and two percent inflation and that, even after employment and inflation are near its objectives, economic conditions may warrant for some time keeping the target federal funds rate below longer-term normal levels. It is unclear when the Federal Reserve will begin and how rapidly the Federal Reserve will unwind its asset holdings. However, as the Federal Reserve unwinds its position, it is expected that excess reserves will be drained from the banking system, which will decrease the overall level of deposits in the system. This could lead to a decline in deposits at some institutions and to increased price competition for stable deposits, which could hamper the improvement in net interest margins that banks are anticipating from rising rates. We cannot predict with any certainty the degree to which the Federal Reserve will continue its accommodative monetary policies, nor the timing of further easing of these policies.

 

17


Table of Contents

Statistical Information

All dollar amounts in the following sections, except per common share data, are in thousands of dollars, except where otherwise indicated.

Selected Quarterly Information

The following chart contains data for the last eight quarters ended December 31, 2014.

 

YEAR

  2014     2013  

QUARTER

  Fourth     Third     Second     First     Fourth     Third     Second     First  
    (in thousands, except per share data)  

Interest income

  $ 15,466      $ 15,753      $ 15,618      $ 15,191      $ 15,539      $ 16,007      $ 14,779      $ 14,608   

Interest expense

    1,092        1,181        1,161        1,147        1,151        1,149        1,263        1,231   

Net interest income

    14,374        14,572        14,458        14,045        14,388        14,858        13,516        13,377   

Provision for loan loss

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          250   

Noninterest income

    1,318        1,197        1,156        1,323        1,563        1,447        1,535        1,281   

Noninterest expense

    9,798        9,149        9,269        9,512        10,045        10,406        9,508        10,773   

Net income

    3,631        4,431        4,148        3,832        3,652        3,940        3,724        2,451   

PER COMMON SHARE DATA

               

Earnings per share- (basic)

  $ 0.20      $ 0.25      $ 0.23      $ 0.22      $ 0.20      $ 0.22      $ 0.21      $ 0.14   

Earnings per share- (diluted)

  $ 0.20      $ 0.25      $ 0.23      $ 0.21      $ 0.20      $ 0.22      $ 0.21      $ 0.13   

Regular cash dividends

  $ 0.10      $ 0.10      $ 0.10      $ 0.10      $ 0.10      $ 0.09      $ 0.09      $ 0.08   

Special cash dividends

  $ 0.05      $ 0.03      $ 0.11      $ 0.10      $ 0.12      $ 0.12      $ 0.05      $ 0.08   

WEIGHTED AVERAGE SHARES OUTSTANDING

               

Basic

    17,717,270        17,749,217        17,889,562        17,897,593        17,888,818        17,888,182        17,872,378        17,835,088   

Diluted

    17,939,752        17,970,458        18,119,412        18,126,188        18,126,273        18,109,282        18,060,081        17,986,519   

 

18


Table of Contents

Investment Portfolio

The following chart contains information regarding the Company’s investment portfolio. All of the Company’s investment securities are accounted for as available-for-sale and are reported at estimated fair value. Temporary differences between estimated fair value and amortized cost, net of deferred taxes, are recorded as a separate component of shareholders’ equity. Credit-related other-than-temporary impairment is recognized against earnings as a realized loss in the period in which it is identified.

INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO

ESTIMATED FAIR VALUE

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Obligations of U.S. government agencies

   $ 39,185       $ 30,847       $ 17,844   

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     83,981         78,795         81,501   

Private label mortgage-backed securities

     3,816         5,314         8,600   

Mortgage-backed securities

     205,390         223,720         281,940   

SBA variable rate pools

     19,574         8,710         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 351,946    $ 347,386    $ 389,885   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following chart presents the fair value of each investment category by maturity date and includes a weighted average yield for each period. Mortgage-backed and private label mortgage-backed securities have been classified based on their December 31, 2014, projected average lives.

SECURITIES AVAILABLE-FOR-SALE

 

     December 31, 2014  
     One Year
or Less
    After One
Year
Through
Five Years
    After Five
Years
Through
Ten Years
    After Ten
Years
 
     Amount      Yield     Amount      Yield     Amount      Yield     Amount      Yield  
     (dollars in thousands)         

Obligations of U.S. government agencies

   $ —           —        $ 16,132         1.55   $ 23,053         2.55   $ —           —     

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     221         3.90     5,653         3.43     38,558         2.88     39,549         2.88

Private label mortgage-backed securities

     —           —          3,280         5.83     536         4.39     —           —     

Mortgage-backed securities

     17,052         1.95     179,876         2.27     8,462         2.30     —           —     

SBA variable rate pools

     —           —          18,599         1.02     975         1.76     —           —     
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total

$ 17,273      1.98 $ 223,540      2.19 $ 71,584      2.70 $ 39,549      2.88
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

 

19


Table of Contents

Loan Portfolio

Average balances and average rates paid by category of loan for the fourth quarter and full year 2014 are included in the Company’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations in this Form 10-K. The following table contains period-end information related to the Company’s loan portfolio for each of the five years ended December 31, 2014.

LOAN PORTFOLIO

 

     December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012     2011     2010  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Commercial and other loans

   $ 408,011      $ 391,229      $ 326,716      $ 274,156      $ 244,764   

Real estate loans

     560,171        500,752        461,240        478,466        522,849   

Construction loans

     73,967        98,910        79,720        63,638        83,455   

Consumer loans

     3,862        3,878        3,581        4,569        5,900   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  1,046,011      994,769      871,257      820,829      856,968   

Deferred loan origination fees, net

  (990   (924   (841   (677   (583
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  1,045,021      993,845      870,416      820,152      856,385   

Allowance for loan losses

  (15,637   (15,917   (16,345   (14,941   (16,570
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
$ 1,029,384    $ 977,928    $ 854,071    $ 805,211    $ 839,815   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table presents loan portfolio information by loan category related to maturity and repricing sensitivity. Variable rate loans are fully floating and can adjust at any time. Adjustable rate loans are fixed for a certain time period, but will adjust at a point in the future, prior to maturity. Variable and adjustable rate loans are included in the time frame in which the interest rate on the loan could be first adjusted. At December 31, 2014, the Company had approximately $92,698 of variable rate loans at their floors and $279,344 of adjustable rate loans at their floors that are included in the analysis below. These loans are included in the category of their next available repricing date.

MATURITY AND REPRICING DATA FOR LOANS

 

     December 31, 2014  
     Commercial and
Other
     Real Estate      Construction      Consumer      Total  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Three months or less

   $ 61,617       $ 49,482       $ 38,697       $ 3,091       $ 152,887   

Over three months through 12 months

     5,217         27,077         23,025         14         55,333   

Over 1 year through 3 years

     39,559         132,395         8,633         110         180,697   

Over 3 years through 5 years

     53,783         261,593         1,912         268         317,556   

Over 5 years through 15 years

     247,835         86,817         —           379         335,031   

Thereafter

     —           2,807         1,700         —           4,507   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loans

$ 408,011    $ 560,171    $ 73,967    $ 3,862    $ 1,046,011   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

20


Table of Contents

Loan Concentrations

At December 31, 2014, loans to dental professionals totaled $306,391 and represented approximately 29.29% of outstanding loans. Approximately 60.00% of the Company’s loans were secured by real estate at December 31, 2014.

Nonperforming Assets

The following table presents period-end nonperforming loans and assets for the five-year periods:

NONPERFORMING ASSETS

 

     December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012     2011     2010  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Nonaccrual loans

   $ 2,695      $ 5,343      $ 9,361      $ 26,594      $ 33,026   

90 or more days past due and still accruing

     —          —          —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonperforming loans

  2,695      5,343      9,361      26,594      33,026   

Government guarantees

  (706   (735   (905   (495   (1,056
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net nonperforming loans

  1,989      4,608      8,456      26,099      31,970   

Other real estate owned

  13,374      16,355      17,972      11,000      14,293   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonperforming assets

$ 15,363    $ 20,963    $ 26,428    $ 37,099    $ 46,263   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Nonperforming assets as a percentage of total assets

  1.02   1.45   1.92   2.92   3.82

If interest on nonaccrual loans had been accrued, such income would have been approximately $100, $421, $708, $1,934 and $2,368, respectively, for the years 2014, 2013, 2012, 2011 and 2010.

 

21


Table of Contents

Allowance for Loan Losses

The following chart presents information about the Company’s allowance for loan losses. Management and the Board of Directors evaluate the allowance monthly and consider the amount to be adequate to absorb possible loan losses.

ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES

 

     December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012     2011     2010  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Balance at beginning of year

   $ 15,917      $ 16,345      $ 14,941      $ 16,570      $ 13,367   

Charges to the allowance

          

Commercial and other loans

     (610     (1,658     (1,401     (1,403     (4,521

Real estate loans

     (58     (407     (1,190     (5,555     (5,913

Construction loans

     (155     —          (1,054     (8,792     (4,949

Consumer loans

     (12     (23     (19     (54     (131
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total charges to the allowance

  (835   (2,088   (3,664   (15,804   (15,514

Recoveries against the allowance

Commercial and other loans

  348      982      1,917      581      1,158   

Real estate loans

  186      360      55      176      2,043   

Construction loans

  16      60      1,188      498      509   

Consumer loans

  5      8      8      20      7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total recoveries against the allowance

  555      1,410      3,168      1,275      3,717   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provisions

  —        250      1,900      12,900      15,000   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at end of the year

$ 15,637    $ 15,917    $ 16,345    $ 14,941    $ 16,570   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge offs as a percentage of total average loans

  0.03   0.07   0.06   1.74   1.30

The following table sets forth the allowance for loan losses allocated by loan type:

 

     December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012     2011     2010  
     (dollars in thousands)  
     Amount     Percent
of loans
in each
category
to total
loans
    Amount      Percent
of loans
in each
category
to total
loans
    Amount      Percent
of loans
in each
category
to total
loans
    Amount      Percent
of loans
in each
category
to total
loans
    Amount      Percent
of loans
in each
category
to total
loans
 

Commercial and other loans

   $ 5,733        39.00   $ 5,113         39.30   $ 3,846         37.50   $ 2,776         33.50   $ 2,230         28.60

Real estate loans

     7,494        53.50     7,668         50.40     9,456         53.00     8,267         58.20     4,520         61.00

Construction loans

     1,077        7.10     1,493         10.00     1,987         9.10     2,104         7.70     8,562         9.70

Consumer loans

     54        0.40     68         0.30     70         0.40     87         0.60     64         0.70

Unallocated

     1,279        N/A        1,575         N/A        986         N/A        1,707         N/A        1,194         N/A   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Allowance for loan losses

$ 15,637      100.00 $ 15,917      100.00 $ 16,345      100.00 $ 14,941      100.00 $ 16,570      100.00
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

During 2014, the Company did not record a provision for loan losses compared to provision of $250 for the year 2013. At December 31, 2014, the Company’s recorded investment in impaired loans, net of government guarantees, was $6,856, with a specific allowance of $245 provided for in the ending allowance for loan losses. See Note 3 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K for additional information regarding the Company’s allowance for loan losses.

 

22


Table of Contents

While the Company saw improvement with regard to the overall credit quality of the loan portfolio in 2014, management cannot predict the level of the provision for loan losses, the level of the allowance for loan losses, or the level of nonperforming assets in future quarters as a result of continuing uncertain economic conditions. At December 31, 2014, and as shown above, the Company’s unallocated reserves were $1,279 or 8.18% of the total allowance for loan losses at year-end. Management believes that the allowance for loan losses at December 31, 2014, was adequate and that this level of unallocated reserves was prudent in light of the economic conditions and uncertainty that exists in the Northwest markets that the Company serves and the concentration in loans to dental professionals. See Note 4 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K for additional information regarding the dental loan portfolio.

Deposits

Average balances and average rates paid by category of deposit are included in Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations in this Form 10-K. The chart below details period-end information related to the Company’s time deposits at December 31, 2014. The Company did not have any foreign deposits at December 31, 2014. Variable rate deposits are listed by first repricing opportunity.

TIME DEPOSITS

 

     December 31, 2014  
     Time Deposits
of $100
or more
     Time Deposits
of less than
$100
     Total
Time Deposits
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

<3 Month

   $ 51,887       $ 10,478       $ 62,365   

3-6 Months

     3,512         4,592         8,104   

6-12 Months

     12,287         7,287         19,574   

>12 Months

     18,723         46,915         65,638   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 86,409    $ 69,272    $ 155,681   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Borrowings

The Company uses short-term borrowings to fund fluctuations in deposits and loan demand. The Bank has access to both secured and unsecured overnight borrowing lines. The secured borrowing lines are collateralized by loans. At December 31, 2014, the Company had secured borrowing lines with the Federal Home Loan Bank of Seattle (the “FHLB”) and the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco (the “FRB”). At December 31, 2014, the FHLB borrowing line was limited by the amount of collateral pledged which limited total borrowings to $318,854. The borrowing line with the FRB is limited by the value of discounted collateral pledged, which at December 31, 2014, was $65,084. At December 31, 2014, the Company also had unsecured borrowing lines with various correspondent banks totaling $129,000. At December 31, 2014, the Company had $0 in overnight borrowings outstanding on its unsecured borrowing lines. At December 31, 2014, there was $416,938 available on secured and unsecured borrowing lines with the FHLB, the FRB, and various correspondent banks.

 

23


Table of Contents

SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS

 

     December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Federal funds purchased, FHLB CMA, FRB, & short-term advances

      

Average interest rate

      

At year end

     0.48     0.25     0.38

For the year

     0.40     0.32     0.53

Average amount outstanding for the year

   $ 121,016      $ 124,671      $ 102,614   

Maximum amount outstanding at any month end

   $ 168,500      $ 158,740      $ 129,385   

Amount outstanding at year end

   $ 68,500      $ 124,150      $ 86,570   

At December 31, 2014, the Company had FHLB borrowings totaling $96,000 with a weighted average interest rate of 0.99% and a remaining average maturity of approximately 2.57 years. More information on long-term borrowings can be found in Note 10 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K.

The Company’s other long-term borrowings consisted of $8,248 in junior subordinated debentures originated on November 28, 2005, and due on January 7, 2036. The interest rate on the debentures was 6.265% until January 2012 after which it was converted to a floating rate of three-month LIBOR plus 135 basis points. In April 2013, the Company entered into a swap agreement with a third party, which fixed the rate on its $8,000 of trust preferred securities at 2.73% for seven years.

 

ITEM 1A Risk Factors

We are subject to numerous risks and uncertainties, including but not limited to the following information:

Industry Factors

The continued challenges in the U.S. and our region’s economies could have a material adverse effect on our future results of operations or market price of our stock; there can be no assurance that U.S. governmental measures responding to these challenges will successfully address these circumstances; the U.S. government continues to face significant fiscal and budgetary challenges which, if not resolved, may further exacerbate U.S. economic conditions.

The national economy and the financial services sector in particular are still facing challenges. A large percentage of our loans are to businesses in western Washington and Oregon, markets facing many of the same challenges as the national economy, including elevated unemployment and weakness in commercial and residential real estate values. Although some economic indicators are improving both nationally and in the markets we serve, there remains uncertainty regarding the strength of the economic recovery. A continued slow economic recovery could result in the following consequences, any of which could have an adverse impact, which may be material, on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects, and could also cause the market price of our stock to decline:

 

    Economic conditions may not stabilize, increasing the likelihood of credit defaults by borrowers.

 

    Loan collateral values, especially as they relate to commercial and residential real estate, may decline, thereby increasing the severity of loss in the event of loan defaults.

 

    Demand for banking products and services may decline, including loan products and services for low cost and noninterest-bearing deposits.

 

    Changes and volatility in interest rates may negatively impact the yields on earning assets and the cost of interest-bearing liabilities.

 

24


Table of Contents

Our earnings and growth are affected not only by general economic conditions, but also by the fiscal and monetary policies of the federal government, particularly the Federal Reserve. Refer to “Supervision and Regulation” in Item 1 of this Form 10-K for discussion of certain of these measures. In response to the adverse financial and economic developments that have, since 2008, impacted the U.S. and global economies and financial markets, and presented challenges for the banking and financial services industry and for our Company, various significant economic and monetary stimulus measures were implemented by the U.S. Congress. The Federal Reserve has been pursuing a highly accommodative monetary policy aimed at keeping interest rates at historically low levels although the Federal Reserve has begun to taper down certain aspects of this policy. It cannot be predicted whether these or other U.S. governmental actions will result in lasting improvement in financial and economic conditions affecting the U.S. banking industry and the U.S. economy. It also cannot be predicted whether and to what extent the efforts of the U.S. government to combat the mixed economic conditions will continue. If, notwithstanding the government’s fiscal and monetary measures, the U.S. economy was to deteriorate, or its recovery was to slow, this would present significant challenges for the U.S. banking and financial services industry and for our Company.

The challenges to the level of economic activity in the U.S., and, therefore, to the banking industry, have also been exacerbated at times in recent years by extensive political disagreements regarding the statutory debt limit on U.S. federal government obligations and measures to address the substantial federal deficits. Following enactment of federal legislation in August 2011 which averted a default by the U.S. federal government on its sovereign obligations by raising the statutory debt limit and which established a process whereby cuts in federal spending may be accomplished, Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services (“Standard & Poor’s”) lowered its long-term sovereign credit rating on the U.S. to “AA+” from “AAA” while affirming its highest rating on short-term U.S. obligations. Standard & Poor’s also stated at the time that its outlook on the long-term rating remained negative; however, in June 2013, Standard & Poor’s revised its outlook on the U.S. credit rating to stable from negative. At the present time, both Fitch Ratings and Moody’s have reaffirmed the U.S.’s “AAA” credit rating and have stated that their outlooks on the long-term ratings continue to be stable. In February 2014, the U.S. Congress passed legislation to increase the statutory debt limit through March 2015 and, in December 2014, Congress passed additional legislation to fund most government agencies through September 2015. Although it is not possible to predict the long-term impact of these developments on the U.S. economy in general and the banking industry in particular, the downgrade by Standard & Poor’s and any further downgrades by it or other rating agencies could increase over time the U.S. federal government’s cost of borrowing which may worsen its fiscal challenges, as well as generating upward pressure on interest rates generally in the U.S. which could, in turn, have adverse consequences for borrowers and the level of business activity.

The outcome and impact of these developments cannot be predicted with any certainty, but could have further adverse consequences for the credit ratings of U.S. debt and also present additional challenges for the U.S. economy and for the U.S. banking industry in general and for our business prospects as well. Any of the foregoing developments could generate further uncertainties and challenges for the U.S. economy which, in turn, could adversely affect the prospects of the banking industry in the U.S. and our business.

Tightening of credit markets and liquidity risk could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

A tightening of the credit markets or any inability to obtain adequate funds at an acceptable cost for continued loan growth could adversely affect our asset growth and liquidity position and, therefore, our earnings capability. In addition to core deposit growth, maturity of investment securities, and loan payments, the Company also relies on wholesale funding sources including unsecured borrowing lines with correspondent banks, secured borrowing lines with the Federal Home Loan Bank of Seattle and the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco, public time certificates of deposits, and out-of-area and brokered time certificates of deposit. Our ability to access these funding sources could be impaired by deterioration in our financial condition as well as factors that are not specific to us, such as a disruption in the financial markets or negative views and expectations for the financial services industry or serious dislocation in the general credit markets. In the event such disruption should occur, our ability to access these funding sources could be adversely affected, both as to price and availability, which would limit, or potentially raise the cost of, the funds available to the Company.

 

25


Table of Contents

The FDIC has increased insurance premiums to rebuild and maintain the federal deposit insurance fund and there may be additional future premium increases and special assessments which would adversely affect our results of operations.

The Bank’s deposits are insured under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, up to the maximum applicable limits, and are subject to deposit insurance assessments designed to tie what banks pay for deposit insurance more closely to the risks they pose. The Dodd-Frank Act broadened the base for FDIC insurance assessments. Assessments are now based on the average consolidated total assets less average tangible equity of a financial institution. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act required the FDIC to increase the designated reserve ratio (the FDIC is required to set the reserve ratio each year) of the Deposit Insurance Fund from 1.15% to 1.35% of insured deposits; required that the fund meet that minimum ratio of insured deposits by 2020; and eliminated the requirement that the FDIC pay dividends to insured depository institutions when the reserve ratio exceeds certain thresholds. See “Supervision and Regulation- Deposit Insurance” in this Form 10-K.

Despite the FDIC’s actions to restore the deposit insurance fund, the fund may suffer additional losses in the future due to failures of insured institutions. There may be additional significant deposit insurance premium increases, special assessments or prepayments in order to restore the insurance fund’s reserve ratio. Any significant premium increases or special assessments could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

Recent levels of market volatility were unprecedented and we cannot predict whether they will return.

From time-to-time since 2008, the capital and credit markets have experienced volatility and disruption at unprecedented levels. In some cases, the markets have produced downward pressure on stock prices and credit availability for certain issuers without regard to those issuers’ underlying financial strength. If similar levels of market disruption and volatility return, we could experience an adverse effect, which may be material, on our ability to access capital and funding and on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We operate in a highly regulated environment and the effects of recent and pending federal legislation or of changes in, or supervisory enforcement of, banking or other laws and regulations could adversely affect us.

As discussed more fully in the section entitled “Supervision and Regulation” in this Form 10-K, we are subject to extensive regulation, supervision and examination by federal and state banking authorities. In addition, as a publicly traded company, we are subject to regulation by the SEC. Any change in applicable regulations or federal, state or local legislation could have a substantial impact on us and our operations. Additional legislation and regulations that could significantly affect our powers, authority and operations may be enacted or adopted in the future, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. New legislation and regulations are likely to increase the overall costs of regulatory compliance and, in many ways, have increased, or may increase in the future, the cost of doing business and present other challenges to the financial services industry.

Regulators have significant discretion and authority to prevent or remedy unsafe or unsound practices or violations of laws or regulations by financial institutions and bank holding companies in the performance of their supervisory and enforcement duties. In recent years, these powers have been utilized more frequently due to the serious national, regional and local economic conditions we are facing. The exercise of regulatory authority may have a negative impact on our financial condition and results of operations.

We cannot accurately predict the ultimate effects of recent legislation or the various governmental, regulatory, monetary and fiscal initiatives which have been and may be enacted on the financial markets, on the Company and on the Bank. The terms and costs of these activities, or the failure of these actions to help stabilize the financial markets, asset prices, market liquidity and a continuation or worsening of current financial market and economic conditions, could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and the trading price of our common stock.

Fluctuating interest rates could adversely affect our profitability.

As is the case with many banks, our profitability is dependent to a large extent upon our net interest income, which is the difference between the interest earned on loans, securities and other interest-earning assets and interest paid on deposits, borrowings, and other interest-bearing liabilities. Because of the differences in maturities and repricing characteristics of our interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, changes in interest rates do not produce equivalent changes in interest income earned on interest-earning assets and interest paid on interest-bearing liabilities. Accordingly, fluctuations in interest rates could adversely affect, and has in past years, impacted, our net interest margin, and, in turn, our profitability. This impact could result in a decrease in our interest income relative to interest expense. Increases in interest rates may also adversely impact the value of our securities investment portfolio. At December 31, 2014, our balance sheet was liability sensitive, and an increase in interest rates could cause our net interest margin and our net interest income to decline. For the past several years,

 

26


Table of Contents

the banking industry has operated in an extremely low interest rate environment relative to historical averages, and the Federal Reserve has pursued highly accommodative monetary policies (including a very low Federal funds rate and substantial purchases of long-term U.S. Treasury and agency securities) in an effort to facilitate growth in the U.S. economy and a reduction in levels of unemployment. This environment has placed downward pressure on the net interest margins of U.S. banks, including Pacific Continental Bank. During 2014, the Federal Reserve began to gradually ease its accommodative monetary policies including discontinuing its asset purchase program in October 2014.We cannot predict with any certainty whether or to what extent the Federal Reserve will continue its accommodative monetary policies, nor the timing of future easing for these policies.

Company Factors

Our allowance for loan losses may not be adequate to cover actual loan losses, which could adversely affect our earnings.

We maintain an allowance for loan losses in an amount that we believe is adequate to provide for losses inherent in our loan portfolio. While we strive to carefully manage and monitor credit quality and to identify loans that may be deteriorating, at any time there are loans included in the portfolio that may result in losses, but that have not yet been identified as potential problem loans. Through established credit practices, we attempt to identify deteriorating loans and adjust the loan loss reserve accordingly. However, because future events are uncertain, there may be loans that deteriorate in an accelerated time frame. As a result, future additions to the allowance at elevated levels may be necessary. Because the loan portfolio contains a number of commercial real estate loans with relatively large balances, deterioration in the credit quality of one or more of these loans may require a significant increase to the allowance for loan losses. Future additions to the allowance may also be required based on changes in the financial condition of borrowers, such as have resulted due to the current, and potentially worsening, economic conditions. Additionally, federal banking regulators, as an integral part of their supervisory function, periodically review our allowance for loan losses. These regulatory agencies may require us to recognize further loan loss provisions or charge-offs based upon their judgments, which may be different from ours. Any increase in the allowance for loan losses would have an adverse effect, which may be material, on our financial condition and results of operations.

Concentration in real estate loans and further deterioration in the real estate markets we serve could require material increases in our allowance for loan losses and adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.

We have a high degree of concentration in loans secured by real estate (see Note 3 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in this Form 10-K). Further deterioration in the local economies we serve could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations due to a weakening of our borrowers’ ability to repay these loans, higher default rates, and a decline in the value of the collateral securing these loans. In light of the continuing effects of the economic downturn, real estate values have been adversely affected. As we have experienced, significant declines in real estate collateral can occur quite suddenly as new appraisals are performed in the normal course of monitoring the credit quality of the loan. Significant declines in the value of real estate collateral due to new appraisals can occur due to declines in the real estate market, changes in methodology applied by the appraiser, and/or using a different appraiser than was used for the prior appraisal. Our ability to recover on these loans by selling or disposing of the underlying real estate collateral is adversely impacted by declining real estate values which increases the likelihood we will suffer losses on defaulted loans secured by real estate beyond the amounts provided for in the allowance for loan losses. This, in turn, could require material increases in our allowance for loan losses and adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations, perhaps materially.

We have a significant concentration in loans to dental professionals, and loan concentrations within one industry may create additional risk.

Bank regulatory authorities and investors generally view significant loan concentrations within any particular industry as carrying higher inherent risk than a loan portfolio without any significant concentration in one industry. We have a significant concentration of loans to dental professionals which represented 29.29% in principal amount of our total loan portfolio at December 31, 2014 (see Note 3 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in this Form 10-K). While we apply credit practices which we believe to be prudent to these loans as well as all the other loans in our portfolio, due to our concentration in dental lending, we are exposed to the general risks of industry concentration, which include adverse market factors impacting that industry alone or disproportionately to other industries. In addition, bank regulatory authorities may in the future require us to limit additional lending in the dental industry if they have concerns that our concentration in that industry creates significant risks, which in turn could limit our ability to pursue new loans in an area where we believe we currently have a competitive advantage.

 

27


Table of Contents

Nonperforming assets take significant time to resolve and adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.

At December 31, 2014, our nonperforming loans (which include all nonaccrual loans, net of government guarantees) were 0.19% of the loan portfolio. At December 31, 2014, our nonperforming assets (which include foreclosed real estate) were 1.02% of total assets. Nonperforming loans and assets adversely affect our net income in various ways. Until economic and market conditions improve, we expect to continue to incur losses relating to nonperforming assets. We generally do not record interest income on nonperforming loans or other real estate owned, thereby adversely affecting our income and increasing our loan administration costs. When we take collateral in foreclosures and similar proceedings, we are required to mark the related asset to the then fair market value of the collateral, less estimated selling expenses, which may ultimately result in a loss. An increase in the level of nonperforming assets increases our risk profile and may impact the capital levels our regulators believe are appropriate in light of the ensuing risk profile. While we reduce problem assets through loan sales, workouts, and restructurings and otherwise, decreases in the value of the underlying collateral, or in these borrowers’ performance or financial condition, whether or not due to economic and market conditions beyond our control, could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition, perhaps materially. In addition, the resolution of nonperforming assets requires significant commitments of time from management and our directors which can be detrimental to the performance of their other responsibilities. Any significant future increase in nonperforming assets could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We may not have the ability to continue paying dividends on our common stock at current or historic levels.

On January 21, 2015, we announced a quarterly cash dividend of $0.10 per share, payable to shareholders of record on February 11, 2015. For the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company paid $0.69 per share in dividends. Our ability to pay dividends on our common stock depends on a variety of factors. It is possible in the future that we may not be able to continue paying quarterly dividends commensurate with historic levels, if at all. As a holding company, a substantial portion of our cash flow typically comes from dividends our bank subsidiary pays to us. Cash dividends will depend on sufficient earnings to support them and adherence to bank regulatory requirements. If the Bank is not able to pay dividends to the Company, the Company may not be able to pay dividends on its common stock. Consequently, the inability to receive dividends from the Bank could adversely affect the Company’s financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

Changes in accounting standards could materially impact our financial statements.

From time to time, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) and the SEC change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our consolidated financial statements or new interpretations of existing standards emerge as standard industry practice. These changes can be very difficult to predict and can materially impact how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations. In some cases, we could be required to apply a new or revised standard retrospectively, resulting in our restating prior period financial statements.

We may be required, in the future, to recognize impairment with respect to investment securities, including the FHLB stock we hold.

Our securities portfolio contains whole loan private mortgage-backed securities and municipal securities and currently includes securities with unrecognized losses. We may continue to observe volatility in the fair market value of these securities. We evaluate the securities portfolio for any other than temporary impairment (“OTTI”) each reporting period, as required by GAAP. Future evaluations of the securities portfolio could require us to recognize impairment charges. The credit quality of securities issued by certain municipalities has deteriorated in recent quarters. Although management does not believe the credit quality of the Company’s municipal securities has similarly deteriorated, such deterioration could occur in the future. For example, it is possible that government-sponsored programs to allow mortgages to be refinanced to lower rates could materially adversely impact the yield on our portfolio of mortgage-backed securities, since a significant portion of our investment portfolio is composed of such securities.

In addition, as a condition to membership in the FHLB, we are required to purchase and hold a certain amount of FHLB stock. Our stock purchase requirement is based, in part, upon the outstanding principal balance of advances from the FHLB. At December 31, 2014, we had stock in the FHLB totaling $10,019. The FHLB stock held by us is carried at cost and is subject to recoverability testing under applicable accounting standards. As of December 31, 2014, we did not recognize an impairment charge related to our FHLB stock holdings. Future negative changes to the financial condition of the FHLB could require us to recognize an impairment charge with respect to such holdings.

 

28


Table of Contents

On January 12, 2015, the FHLB Seattle announced that the Federal Housing Finance Agency has approved the merger application of the FHLB Seattle and the FHLB Des Moines. The merger is expected to close in May 2015. At that time, the combined entity will be buying back excess stock above what is needed to support borrowings. If the merger is completed, this has the potential to result in a decrease of the Bank’s outstanding FHLB stock.

If the goodwill we have recorded in connection with acquisitions becomes impaired, it could have an adverse impact on our reported earnings.

At December 31, 2014, we had $22,881 of goodwill on our balance sheet. In accordance with GAAP, our goodwill is not amortized but rather evaluated for impairment on an annual basis or more frequently if events or circumstances indicate that a potential impairment exists. Such evaluation is based on a variety of qualitative and quantitative factors, including macroeconomic conditions, industry and market conditions, cost factors, overall financial performance, and other relevant entity-specific events. The last impairment test was performed at December 31, 2014. At December 31, 2014, we did not recognize an impairment charge related to our goodwill. Future evaluations of goodwill may result in findings of impairment and write-downs, which would impact our operating results and could be material.

We face strong competition from financial services companies and other companies that offer banking services.

Our three major markets are in Oregon and Washington. The banking and financial services businesses in our market area are highly competitive, and increased competition may adversely impact the level of our loans and deposits. Ultimately, we may not be able to compete successfully against current and future competitors. These competitors include national banks, foreign banks, regional banks and other community banks. We also face competition from many other types of financial institutions, including savings and loan associations, finance companies, brokerage firms, insurance companies, credit unions, mortgage banks and other financial intermediaries. In particular, our competitors include major financial companies whose greater resources may afford them a marketplace advantage by enabling them to maintain numerous locations and mount extensive promotional and advertising campaigns. Areas of competition include interest rates for loans and deposits, efforts to obtain loan and deposit customers and a range in quality of products and services provided, including new technology-driven products and services. If we are unable to attract and retain banking customers, we may be unable to develop loan growth or maintain our current level of deposits, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

A failure in our operational systems or infrastructure, or those of third-parties, could impair our liquidity, disrupt our businesses, result in the unauthorized disclosure of confidential information, damage our reputation and cause financial losses.

We are dependent on third-parties and their ability to process and monitor, on a daily basis, a large number of transactions, many of which are highly complex, across numerous and diverse markets. These transactions, as well as the information technology services we provide to clients, often must adhere to client-specific guidelines, as well as legal and regulatory standards. Due to the breadth of our client base and our geographical reach, developing and maintaining our operational systems and infrastructure is challenging, particularly as a result of rapidly evolving legal and regulatory requirements and technological shifts. Our financial, accounting, data processing or other operating systems and facilities may fail to operate properly or become disabled as a result of events that are wholly or partially beyond our control, such as electrical, internet or telecommunications outages, a spike in transaction volume, a cyber-security attack or other unforeseen catastrophic events, which may adversely affect our ability to process these transactions or provide services.

In addition, our operations rely on the secure processing, storage, transmission and reporting of personal, confidential and other sensitive information or data on our computer systems, networks and business applications. Although we take numerous protective measures to maintain the confidentiality, integrity and availability of our and our clients’ information across all geographic and product lines, and endeavor to modify these protective measures as circumstances warrant, the nature of the threats continues to evolve. As a result, our computer systems, software and networks may be vulnerable to breaches, unauthorized access, loss or destruction of data (including confidential client information), account takeovers, unavailability of service, computer viruses or other malicious code, cyber-security attacks and other events that could have an adverse security impact and significant negative consequences to us. Despite the defensive measures we take to manage our internal technological and operational infrastructure, these threats may originate externally from third-parties, such as foreign governments, organized crime and other hackers, and outsource or infrastructure-support providers and application developers, or the threats may originate from within our organization. These events could result in litigation or financial losses that are either not insured against or not fully covered by insurance, regulatory consequences or reputational harm, any of which could harm our competitive position, operating results and financial condition. These types of incidents can remain undetected for extended periods of time, thereby increasing the associated risks. We may also be required to expend significant resources to modify our protective measures or to investigate and remediate vulnerabilities or exposures arising from cyber-security risks.

 

29


Table of Contents

We also face the risk of operational disruption, failure, termination or capacity constraints of any of the third-parties that facilitate our business activities, including exchanges, clearing agents, clearing houses or other financial intermediaries. Such parties could also be the source of an attack on, or breach of, our operational systems, data or infrastructure. In addition, as interconnectivity with our clients grows, we increasingly face the risk of operational failure with respect to our clients’ systems.

Other financial institutions have been the target of various denial-of-service or other cyber-attacks as part of what appears to be a coordinated effort to disrupt the operations of financial institutions and potentially test their cybersecurity in advance of future and more advanced cyber-attacks. These denial-of-service attacks require substantial resources to defend, and may affect customer satisfaction and behavior. In addition, there have been increasing efforts on the part of third parties to breach data security at financial institutions as well as the other types of companies, such as large retailers, or with respect to financial transactions, including through the use of social engineering schemes such as “phishing”. The ability of our customers to bank remotely, including online and through mobile devices, requires secure transmissions of confidential information and increase the risk of data security breaches which would expose us to financial claims by customers or others and which could adversely affect our reputation. Even if cyber-attacks and similar tactics are not directed specifically at Pacific Continental Bank, such attacks on other large financial institutions could disrupt the overall functioning of the financial systems and undermine consumer confidence in banks generally, to the detriment of other financial institutions, including the Bank.

To date we have not experienced any material losses relating to a cyber-security incident or other information security breaches, but there can be no assurance that we will not suffer such losses or information security breaches in the future. If one or more of these events occurs, it could potentially jeopardize the confidential, proprietary and other information processed and stored in, and transmitted through, our computer systems and networks, or otherwise cause interruptions or malfunctions in our, as well as our clients’ or other third-parties’, operations which could result in damage to our reputation, substantial costs, regulatory penalties and/or client dissatisfaction or loss. Potential costs of a cyber-security incident may include, but would not be limited to, remediation costs, increased protection costs, lost revenue from the unauthorized use of proprietary information or the loss of current and/or future customers, and litigation.

We maintain an insurance policy which we believe provides sufficient coverage at a manageable expense for an institution of our size and scope with similar technological systems. However, we cannot assure that this policy would be sufficient to cover all financial losses, damages, penalties, including lost revenues, should we experience any one or more of our or a third-party’s systems failing or experiencing attack.

Our business and financial results could be impacted materially by adverse results in legal or regulatory proceedings.

As is the case with other banking institutions, we are from time to time subject to claims and proceedings related to our present or previous operations. In addition, we may be the subject of governmental investigations and other forms of regulatory inquiry from time to time. The results of these legal proceedings and governmental investigations and inquiries could lead to significant monetary damages or penalties, restrictions on the way in which we conduct our business, or reputational harm, and could involve significant defense or other costs. Although we establish accruals for legal proceedings when information related to the loss contingencies represented by those matters indicates both that a loss is probable and that the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated, we do not have accruals for all legal proceedings where we face a risk of loss. In addition, amounts accrued may not represent the ultimate loss to us from the legal proceedings in question. Thus, our ultimate losses may be higher or lower, and possibly significantly so, than the amounts accrued for legal loss contingencies. To mitigate the cost of some of these claims, we maintain insurance coverage in amounts and with deductibles that we believe are appropriate for our operations. However, our insurance coverage does not cover any civil money penalties or fines imposed by government authorities and may not cover all other claims that have been or might be brought against us, or continue to be available to us at a reasonable cost. As a result, we may be exposed to substantial uninsured liabilities, which could adversely affect our business, prospects, results of operations and financial condition.

 

30


Table of Contents

Risks associated with potential acquisitions and expansion activities or divestitures may disrupt our business and adversely affect our operating results.

We regularly evaluate potential acquisitions and expansion opportunities. We have in the past, and may in the future, seek to expand our business by acquiring other businesses which we believe will enhance our business. We cannot predict the frequency, size or timing of our acquisitions, as this will depend on the availability of prospective target opportunities at valuation levels we find attractive and the competition for such opportunities from other parties. There can be no assurance that our acquisitions will have the anticipated positive results, including results related to: the total cost of integration; the retention of key personnel; the time required to complete the integration; the amount of longer-term cost savings; continued growth; or the overall performance of the acquired company or combined entity. We also may encounter difficulties in obtaining required regulatory approvals and unexpected contingent liabilities can arise from the businesses we acquire. Further, the asset quality or other financial characteristics of a business or assets we may acquire may deteriorate after an acquisition agreement is signed or after an acquisition closes, which could result in impairment or other expenses and charges which would reduce our operating results. Integration of an acquired business can be complex and costly. If we are not able to integrate successfully past or future acquisitions, there is a risk that results of operations could be adversely affected. To the extent that we grow through acquisitions, there is a risk that we will not be able to adequately or profitably manage this growth. In addition, we may sell or restructure portions of our business. Any divestitures or restructuring may result in significant expenses and write-offs, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition, and may involve additional risks, including difficulties in obtaining any required regulatory approvals, the diversion of management’s attention from other business concerns, the disruption of our business and the potential loss of key employees. We may not be successful in addressing these or any other significant risks encountered in connection with any acquisition or divestitures we might make.

We may pursue additional capital in the future, which could dilute the holders of our outstanding common stock and may adversely affect the market price of our common stock.

From time to time, particularly in the current uncertain economic environment, we may consider alternatives for raising capital when opportunities present themselves, in order to further strengthen our capital and/or better position ourselves to take advantage of identified or potential opportunities that may arise in the future. Such alternatives may include issuance and sale of common or preferred stock, or borrowings by the Company, with proceeds contributed to the Bank. Any such capital raising alternatives could dilute the holders of our outstanding common stock and may adversely affect the market price of our common stock.

Anti-takeover provisions in our amended and restated articles of incorporation and bylaws and Oregon law could make a third-party acquisition of us difficult.

Our amended and restated articles of incorporation contain provisions that could make it more difficult for a third-party to acquire us (even if doing so would be beneficial to our shareholders) and for holders of our common stock to receive any related takeover premium for their common stock. We are also subject to certain provisions of Oregon law that could delay, deter or prevent a change in control of us. These provisions could limit the price that investors might be willing to pay in the future for shares of our common stock.

 

ITEM 1B Unresolved Staff Comments

None

 

31


Table of Contents
ITEM 2 Properties

The principal properties of the Company are comprised of the banking facilities owned by the Bank. The Bank operates fourteen full-service facilities and two loan production offices. The Bank owns a total of eight buildings and, with the exception of two of those buildings, owns the land on which these buildings are situated. Significant properties owned by the Bank are as follows:

 

1) Three-story building and land with approximately 35,000 square feet located on Olive Street in Eugene, Oregon.

 

2) Building with approximately 4,000 square feet located on West 11th Avenue in Eugene, Oregon. The building is on leased land.

 

3) Building and land with approximately 8,000 square feet located on High Street in Eugene, Oregon.

 

4) Three-story building and land with approximately 36,000 square feet located in Springfield, Oregon. The Company occupies approximately 5,500 square feet of the first floor and approximately 10,763 square feet on the second floor and leases, or is seeking to lease, the remaining space.

 

5) Building and land with approximately 4,000 square feet located in Beaverton, Oregon.

 

6) Building and land with approximately 2,000 square feet located in Junction City, Oregon.

 

7) Building and land with approximately 5,000 square feet located near the Convention Center in Portland, Oregon.

 

8) Building with approximately 7,000 square feet located at the Nyberg Shopping Center in Tualatin, Oregon. The building is on leased land.

The Bank leases facilities for branch offices in Eugene, Oregon, Portland, Oregon, Seattle, Washington, Bellevue, Washington, and Vancouver, Washington. The Company also leases facilities for a loan production office in Tacoma, Washington. In addition, the Company leases a portion of an adjoining building to the High Street office for administrative and training functions. Management considers all owned and leased facilities adequate for current use.

 

ITEM 3 Legal Proceedings

On August 23, 2013, a putative class action lawsuit (Class Action) was filed in the Circuit Court of the State of Oregon for the County of Multnomah on behalf of individuals who placed money with Berjac of Oregon and Berjac of Portland, both currently in Chapter 11 bankruptcy. The lawsuit, which initally asserted two claims for violations of state securities laws and a third claim for aiding breach of tort duties, names Pacific Continental Bank, along with the Holcomb Family Limited Partnership, Fred “Jack” W. Holcomb, Holcomb Family Trust, Jones & Roth, P.C. and Umpqua Bank, as defendants. Claimants seek the return of the money placed with Berjac of Oregon and Berjac of Portland, plus interest, and costs and attorneys’ fees. Those complaints indicate the range of damages sought by the putative class, which are claimed to be in excess of $10 million.

The Class Action was removed from Oregon state court to the Federal District Court for the District of Oregon. On October 27, 2014, the federal court granted plaintiffs’ motion to remand the case to state court under exceptions to the Class Action Fairness Act but also referred the case to the U.S. Bankruptcy Court for the District of Oregon to resolve the issue of equitable remand of the case to state court. On January 14, 2015, the U.S. Bankruptcy Court granted plaintiffs’ motion to remand. The Class Action is now pending in the Circuit Court of the State of Oregon for the County of Multnomah. After defendants filed motions to dismiss, the plaintiffs amended their complaint in the federal court proceedings, asserting one claim for violations of Oregon securities laws and omitting the second claim for violations of Oregon securities laws and the third claim for aiding breach of fiduciary duty. The Federal Court did not resolve the motions to dismiss before the case was remanded to State Court. Plaintiffs have indicated that they intend to amend their complaint but have not done so as of the date of this form 10-K.

On August 28, 2014, the court-appointed bankruptcy trustee for Berjac of Oregon (the surviving entity in the merger of Berjac of Oregon and Berjac of Portland) filed an adversary complaint (Trustee’s Lawsuit) in the U.S Bankruptcy Court for the District of Oregon alleging that the Company, the Bank, Umpqua Bank, Century Bank and Summit Bank provided lines of credit that enabled continuation of the alleged Ponzi scheme operated by Berjac of Oregon and the two partners of the pre-existing Berjac general partnerships, Michael Holcomb and Gary Holcomb. Pacific Continental Corporation acquired Century Bank on February 1, 2013.

In addition to seeking an award of punitive damages, the trustee is seeking the recovery of payments associated with allegedly fraudulent transfers from Century Bank and Pacific Continental Bank. The complaint also alleges that accounting firm Jones & Roth, P.C., is jointly and severally liable for the return of the allegedly fraudulent transfers to the bankruptcy estate.

 

32


Table of Contents

Among other claims for relief, the trustee is seeking the disgorgement of monies advanced to the Holcomb Family Limited Partnership by Century Bank and returned to the estate by court order following the post-petition cash collateral hearing, and of monies received by Pacific Continental Bank from the proceeds of the sale of stock held by the Holcomb Family Limited Partnership and securing one of the lines of credit previously held by Century Bank. Those complaints indicate the range of damages sought by the Trustee which include, among other claims for relief, an award of punitive damages not to exceed $10 million, recovery of payments associated with allegedly fraudulent transfers totaling up to approximately $55.3 million, including up to $23.0 million from Century Bank and up to $6.3 million from Pacific Continental Bank. Pacific Continental Bank has filed a motion with the U.S. District Court for the District of Oregon to withdraw reference of the case from the U.S. Bankruptcy Court. The motion is unopposed but under consideration as of the date of This Form 10-K. Motions to dismiss filed by Pacific Continental Bank and other defendants are also pending as of the date of this form 10-K.

We may from time to time be involved in claims, proceedings and litigation arising from our business and property ownership. Based on currently available information, the Company does not expect that the results of such proceedings, including the above-described proceeding, in the aggregate, to have a material adverse effect on our financial condition.

 

ITEM 4 Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

 

33


Table of Contents

PART II

 

ITEM 5 Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Market Information and Shareholders

The Company’s common stock is traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol PCBK. At February 28, 2015, the Company had 17,718,778 shares of common stock outstanding held by approximately 671shareholders of record.

The high, low and closing sales prices (based on daily closing price) for the last eight quarters are shown in the table below.

 

YEAR    2014      2013  
QUARTER    Fourth      Third      Second      First      Fourth      Third      Second      First  

Market value:

                       

High

   $ 14.48       $ 14.18       $ 14.81       $ 16.02       $ 16.27       $ 13.69       $ 11.80       $ 11.51   

Low

     12.83         12.85         13.07         13.32         12.54         11.79         10.10         9.61   

Close

     14.18         12.85         13.73         13.76         15.94         13.11         11.80         11.17   

Dividends

The Company has generally paid cash dividends on a quarterly basis. Cash dividends, when and if declared, will be declared and announced simultaneously with the Company’s quarterly earnings releases in January, April, July, and October each year with dividends, if any, to be paid in February, May, August, and November. The Board of Directors considers the dividend amount quarterly and takes a broad perspective in its dividend deliberations, including a review of recent operating performance, capital levels, and concentrations of loans as a percentage of capital, as well as growth projections. The Board also considers dividend payout ratios, dividend yield, and other financial metrics in setting the quarterly dividend. Regulatory authorities may prohibit the Company from paying dividends in a manner that would constitute an unsafe or unsound banking practice or would reduce the amount of its capital below that necessary to meet minimum applicable regulatory capital requirements. Current guidance from the Federal Reserve provides, among other things, that dividends per share generally should not exceed earnings per share, measured over the previous four fiscal quarters.

 

YEAR    2014      2013  
QUARTER    Fourth      Third      Second      First      Fourth      Third      Second      First  

Regular cash dividend

   $ 0.10       $ 0.10       $ 0.10       $ 0.10       $ 0.10       $ 0.09       $ 0.09       $ 0.08   

Special cash dividend

     0.05         0.03         0.11         0.10         0.12         0.12         0.05         0.08   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total dividend

$ 0.15    $ 0.13    $ 0.21    $ 0.20    $ 0.22    $ 0.21    $ 0.14    $ 0.16   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

34


Table of Contents

Equity Compensation Plan Information

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2014  
     Number of shares to be
issued upon exercise of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights (2)
     Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights (2) (3)
     Number of shares remaining
available for future issuance
under equity compensation
plans (2)
 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders(1)

     922,848       $ 14.07         433,214   

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

     —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

  922,848    $ 14.07      433,214   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  Under the Company’s respective equity compensation plans, the Company may grant incentive stock options and non-qualified stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units and stock appreciation rights to its employees and directors; however, only employees may receive incentive stock options.
(2)  All amounts have been adjusted to reflect subsequent stock splits and stock dividends.
(3) Weighted average exercise price is based solely on equity grants with an exercise price.

Share Repurchase Plan

On May 6, 2014, the Company adopted a repurchase plan to purchase up to five percent of the Company’s outstanding shares. For the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, the company purchased a total of 267,080 shares of common stock at a weighted average price of $13.48.

 

Period

   Total
Number
of
Shares
Purchased
     Average Price
Paid Per Share
     Total Number of Shares
Purchased as Part of Publicly
Announced Plan
     Maximum Number of Shares
that May Yet Be Purchased
Under the Plan
 

January 1-31, 2014

     —           n/a         —           —     

February 1-28, 2014

     —           n/a         —           —     

March 1-31, 2014

     —           n/a         —           —     

April 1-30, 2014

     —         $ 13.28         11,400         881,100   

May 1-31, 2014

     —         $ 13.37         123,322         757,778   

June 1-30, 2014

     —           n/a         —           —     

July 1-31, 2014

     —         $ 13.60         94,389         663,389   

August 1-31, 2014

     —         $ 13.59         37,969         625,420   

September 1-30, 2014

     —           n/a         —           —     

October 1-31, 2014

     —           n/a         —           —     

November 1-30, 2014

     —           n/a         —           —     

December 1-31, 2014

     —           n/a         —           —     

 

35


Table of Contents

Performance Graph

The information contained in the following chart entitled “Total Return Performance” is not considered to be “soliciting material,” or “filed,” or incorporated by reference in any past or future filing by the Company under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 or the Securities Act of 1933 unless and only to the extent that the Company may specifically incorporate it by reference.

 

LOGO

The above graph and following table compares the total cumulative shareholder return on the Company’s Common Stock, based on reinvestment of all dividends, to the cumulative total returns of the Russell 2000 Index and SNL Securities $1 Billion to $5 Billion Bank Asset Size Index. The graph assumes $100 invested on December 31, 2009, in the Company’s Common Stock and each of the indices.

 

     Period Ending  

Index

   12/31/09      12/31/10      12/31/11      12/31/12      12/31/13      12/31/14  

Pacific Continental Corporation

     100.00         88.31         78.56         89.38         155.44         145.20   

Russell 2000

     100.00         126.86         121.56         141.43         196.34         205.95   

SNL Bank $1B-$5B

     100.00         113.35         103.38         127.47         185.36         193.81   

 

36


Table of Contents
ITEM 6 Selected Financial Data

Selected financial data for the past five years is shown in the table below.

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share data)

 

     For the year ended December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012     2011     2010  
     (in thousands, except per share data)  

Net interest income

   $ 57,448      $ 56,139      $ 50,076      $ 51,169      $ 51,261   

Provision for loan losses

     —          250        1,900        12,900        15,000   

Noninterest income

     4,995        5,826        5,741        5,866        4,649   

Noninterest expense

     37,729        40,732        35,105        37,076        33,094   

Income tax expense

     8,672        7,216        6,159        1,718        2,724   

Net income

     16,042        13,767        12,653        5,341        5,092   

Cash dividends

     12,308        13,050        5,588        1,842        736   

Per common share data

          

Net income (loss):

          

Basic

   $ 0.90      $ 0.77      $ 0.70      $ 0.29      $ 0.28   

Diluted

     0.89        0.76        0.69        0.29        0.28   

Regular cash dividends

   $ 0.40      $ 0.36      $ 0.24      $ 0.10      $ 0.04   

Special cash dividends

     0.29        0.37        0.07        —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total dividends

$ 0.69    $ 0.73    $ 0.31    $ 0.10    $ 0.04   

Book value

$ 10.39    $ 10.01    $ 10.28    $ 9.70    $ 9.35   

Tangible book value(3)

  9.07      8.69      9.05      8.50      8.13   

Market value, end of year

  14.18      15.94      9.73      8.85      10.06   

At year end

Assets

$ 1,504,325    $ 1,449,726    $ 1,373,487    $ 1,270,232    $ 1,210,176   

Loans, less allowance for loan loss (1)

  1,029,384      977,928      854,071      806,269      841,931   

Available-for-sale securities

  351,946      347,386      389,885      346,542      253,907   

Core deposits (2)

  1,110,861      990,315      938,629      885,843      895,838   

Total deposits

  1,209,093      1,090,981      1,046,154      965,254      958,959   

Shareholders’ equity

  184,161      179,184      183,381      178,866      172,238   

Tangible equity (3)

  160,666      155,568      161,350      156,631      149,780   

Average for the year

Assets

$ 1,477,060    $ 1,433,213    $ 1,317,094    $ 1,226,715    $ 1,189,289   

Earning assets

  1,362,157      1,312,660      1,204,289      1,124,948      1,090,261   

Loans, less allowance for loan loss (1)

  1,010,182      943,381      816,655      817,915      887,594   

Available-for-sale securities

  348,049      365,889      384,810      304,424      198,507   

Core deposits (2)

  1,031,140      967,592      877,256      879,779      827,082   

Total deposits

  1,132,428      1,074,166      972,854      945,187      904,169   

Interest-paying liabilities

  913,018      912,022      833,680      781,925      799,638   

Shareholders’ equity

  181,762      180,857      181,475      177,256      170,758   

Financial ratios

Return on average:

Assets

  1.09   0.96   0.96   0.44   0.43

Equity

  8.83   7.61   6.97   3.01   2.98

Tangible equity (3)

  10.14   8.75   7.94   3.45   3.44

Avg shareholders’ equity / avg assets

  12.31   12.62   13.78   14.45   14.36

Dividend payout ratio

  76.72   94.79   44.16   34.49   14.45

Regulatory Capital

Tier 1 leverage capital

  11.33   11.49   12.33   13.09   13.38

Tier I risked-based capital

  14.48   14.90   16.90   17.97   15.86

Total risk-based capital

  15.73   16.15   18.15   19.22   17.10

 

(1)  Outstanding loans include loans held-for-sale and net deferred fees.
(2)  Core deposits include all demand, interest checking, money market, savings and local non-public time deposits, including local non-public time deposits in excess of $100.
(3)  Tangible book value per share and tangible equity exclude goodwill and core deposit intangibles related to acquisitions. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” - “Results of Operations Overview” in this Form 10-K for a reconciliation of non-GAAP financial measures.

 

37


Table of Contents
ITEM 7 Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operation

The following discussion is intended to provide a more comprehensive review of the Company’s operating results and financial condition than can be obtained from reading the Consolidated Financial Statements alone. The discussion should be read in conjunction with the audited financial statements and the notes included later in this Form 10-K. All dollar amounts, except per share data, are expressed in thousands of dollars.

HIGHLIGHTS

 

     2014     2013     % Change
2014 vs. 2013
    2012     % Change
2013 vs. 2012
 
     (in thousands, except per share data)  

Net income

   $ 16,042      $ 13,767        16.53   $ 12,653        8.80

Operating revenue (1)

     62,443        61,965        0.77     55,817        11.01

Earnings per share

          

Basic

   $ 0.90      $ 0.77        16.9   $ 0.70        10.0

Diluted

   $ 0.89      $ 0.76        17.1   $ 0.69        10.1

Assets, period-end

   $ 1,504,325      $ 1,449,726        3.8   $ 1,373,487        5.6

Gross loans, period-end (2)

     1,046,011        994,769        5.2     871,257        14.2

Core deposits, period-end (3)

     1,110,861        990,315        12.2     938,629        5.5

Deposits, period-end

     1,209,093        1,090,981        10.8     1,046,154        4.3

Return on average assets

     1.09     0.96       0.96  

Return on average equity

     8.83     7.61       6.97  

Return on average tangible equity (4)

     10.14     8.75       7.94  

Avg shareholders’ equity / avg assets

     12.31     12.62       13.78  

Dividend payout ratio

     76.73     94.79       44.16  

Net interest margin (5)

     4.30     4.36       4.23  

Efficiency ratio

     59.41     65.73       62.89  

 

(1)  Operating revenue is defined as net interest income plus noninterest income.
(2)  Excludes net deferred fees and allowance for loan losses.
(3)  Defined by the Company as demand, interest checking, money market, savings and local non-public time deposits, including local non-public time deposits in excess of $100.
(4)  Tangible equity excludes goodwill and core deposit intangibles related to acquisitions.
(5)  Presentation of net interest margin for all periods reported has been adjusted to a tax- equivalent basis using a 35% tax rate.

Results of Operations—Overview

The Company recorded net income of $16,042 for the year ended 2014, an improvement of $2,275 or 16.53% over the prior year. The results for 2014 and 2013 included $470 and $1,246, respectively, in merger related expenses associated with the pending acquisition of Capital Pacific Bancorp and the February 2013 Century Bank acquisition. Improvement in 2014 net income over 2013 was due to increased revenues, specifically net interest income, lower provision for loan losses and a decline in noninterest expense. The increase in net interest income was attributable to an increase in organic loan and improvement in the yield on the securities portfolio. The Company made no provision for loan losses in 2014 compared to $250 in 2013. This decline was primarily due to reductions in classified assets and nonperforming loans. Net income also benefitted from a decline of $3,003 in noninterest expense, primarily due to reductions in the following categories of expense: 1) business development; 2) bankcard processing; 3) other real estate; 4) merger related; and 5) the other expense category. A portion of the decline in these expense categories was offset by an increase of $1,435 or 6.49% in salaries and employee benefits.

 

38


Table of Contents

The Company recorded net income of $13,767 for the year ended 2013, an improvement of $1,114 or 8.80% over the prior year. The results for 2013 included $1,246 in merger related expenses associated with the acquisition of Century Bank during the first quarter 2013. Improvement in 2013 net income over 2012 was due to increased revenues, specifically net interest income and a lower provision for loan losses, which more than offset an increase in noninterest expense. The increase in net interest income was attributable to an increase in loans, both loans acquired in the Century Bank transaction and organic loan growth, combined with an improvement in the net interest margin. The provision for loan losses in 2013 was $250, down $1,650 from 2012. This decline was due to reductions in classified assets and nonperforming loans and recoveries booked during the year. A portion of the improvement in net interest income and the provision for loan losses was offset by higher noninterest expenses, primarily personnel expense, other real estate expense, and merger related expenses

Year-end assets at December 31, 2014, were $1,504,325, up $54,599 or 3.77% from December 31, 2013, asset totals. Growth in assets was due to an increase in outstanding net loans. The Company experienced a typical seasonal core deposit pattern in 2014 with deposit outflows occurring during the first half of the year followed by growth in core deposits during the second half of the year. Outstanding core deposits were $1,110,861 at December 31, 2014, up $120,546 or 12.17% over the prior year-end. Growth in the Company’s demand deposits accounted for $40,420 of the increase in core deposits and were up 11.02% over December 31, 2013, outstanding demand deposits.

Average assets for the year ended 2014 were $1,477,060 up $43,847 or 3.06% over 2013, due to growth in average outstanding loans. Growth in average loans in 2014 over the prior year was primarily funded by growth in core deposits. Average core deposits for the year ended 2014 were $1,031,140, up $63,548 or 6.57% over average core deposits in 2013.

During 2015, the Company believes the following factors could impact our financial results, in addition to those described in “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this Form 10-K:

 

    Changes and volatility in interest rates could negatively impact yields on earning assets and the cost of interest-bearing liabilities, thus negatively affecting the Company’s net interest margin and net interest income.

 

    Global economic weakness and a potential rise in short-term interest rates could lead to a slowdown of economic growth, thus negatively affecting loan demand, causing a decline in banking industry revenues.

 

    The ability to manage noninterest expense growth in light of anticipated increases in regulatory compliance cost.

 

    The competition to attract and retain qualified and experienced bankers in our markets.

Reconciliation of non-GAAP financial information

Management utilizes certain non-GAAP financial measures to monitor the Company’s performance. While we believe the presentation of non-GAAP financial measures provides additional insight into our operating performance, readers of this report are urged to review the GAAP results as presented in the Financial Statements and Supplementary Data in this Form 10-K.

The Company presents a computation of tangible equity along with tangible book value and return on average tangible equity. The Company defines tangible equity as total shareholders’ equity before goodwill and core deposit intangible assets. Tangible book value is calculated as tangible equity divided by total shares outstanding. Return on average tangible equity is calculated as net income divided by average tangible equity. We believe that tangible equity and certain tangible equity ratios are meaningful measures of capital adequacy which may be used when making period-to-period and company-to-company comparisons. Tangible equity and tangible equity ratios are considered to be non-GAAP financial measures and should be viewed in conjunction with total shareholders’ equity, book value and return on average equity. The following table presents a reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity to tangible equity.

 

39


Table of Contents
     December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012  
     (in thousands, except per share data)  

Total shareholders’ equity

   $ 184,161      $ 179,184      $ 183,381   

Subtract:

      

Goodwill

     (22,881     (22,881     (22,031

Core deposit intangibles

     (614     (735     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tangible shareholders’ equity (non-GAAP)

$ 160,666    $ 155,568    $ 161,350   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Book value

$ 10.39    $ 10.01    $ 10.28   

Tangible book value (non-GAAP)

$ 9.07    $ 8.69    $ 9.05   
     2014     2013     2012  

Average Total shareholders’ equity

   $ 181,762      $ 180,856      $ 181,475   

Subtract:

      

Average Goodwill

     (22,881     (22,667     (22,031

Average Core deposit intangibles

     (674     (724     (95
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average Tangible shareholders’ equity (non-GAAP)

$ 158,207    $ 157,465    $ 159,349   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Return on average equity

  8.83   7.61   6.97

Return on average tangible equity (non-GAAP)

  10.14   8.75   7.94

Non-GAAP financial measures have inherent limitations, are not required to be uniformly applied, and are not audited. Although we believe these non-GAAP financial measure are frequently used by stakeholders in the evaluation of a company, they have limitations as analytical tools, and should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for analyses of results as reported under GAAP.

SUMMARY OF CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

We follow accounting standards set by the Financial Accounting Standards Board, commonly referred to as the “FASB.” The FASB sets generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) that we follow to ensure we consistently report our financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows. References to GAAP issued by the FASB in this report are to the “FASB Accounting Standards Codification”, sometimes referred to as the “Codification,” or “ASC.” The FASB finalized the Codification effective for periods ending on or after September 15, 2009. Prior FASB Statements, Interpretations, Positions, EITF consensuses, and AICPA Statements of Position are no longer being issued by the FASB. The Codification does not change how the Company accounts for its transactions or the nature of related disclosures made. However, when referring to guidance issued by the FASB, the Company refers to topics in the ASC rather than the specific FASB statement. We have updated references to GAAP in this report to reflect the guidance in the Codification.

The SEC defines “critical accounting policies” as those that require the application of management’s most difficult, subjective or complex judgments, often as a result of the need to make estimates about the effect of matters that are inherently uncertain and may change in future periods. Significant accounting policies are described in Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K. Management believes that the following policies and those disclosed in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements should be considered critical under the SEC definition:

Nonaccrual Loans

Accrual of interest is discontinued on contractually delinquent loans when management believes that, after considering economic and business conditions and collection efforts, the borrower’s financial condition is such that collection of principal or interest is doubtful. At a minimum, loans that are past due as to maturity or payment of principal or interest by 90 days or more are placed on nonaccrual status, unless such loans are well-secured and in the process of collection. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received satisfying all delinquent principal and interest amounts, and the prospects for future payments in accordance with the loan agreement appear relatively certain. In accordance with GAAP, payments received on nonaccrual loans are applied to the principal balance and no interest income is recognized.

 

40


Table of Contents

Allowance for Loan Losses and Reserve for Unfunded Commitments

The allowance for loan losses on outstanding loans is classified as a contra-asset account offsetting outstanding loans, and the allowance for unfunded commitments is classified as an “other” liability on the balance sheet. The allowance for loan losses is established through a provision for loan losses charged against earnings. The balances of the allowance for loan losses for outstanding loans and unfunded commitments are maintained at an amount management believes will be adequate to absorb known and inherent losses in the loan portfolio and commitments to loan funds. The appropriate balance of the allowance for loan losses is determined by applying loss factors to the credit exposure from outstanding loans and unfunded loan commitments. Estimated loss factors are based on subjective measurements including management’s assessment of the internal risk classifications, changes in the nature of the loan portfolios, industry concentrations, and the impact of current local, regional, and national economic factors on the quality of the loan portfolio. Changes in these estimates and assumptions are reasonably possible and may have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements, results of operations or liquidity.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

In the normal course of business, the Company may modify the terms of certain loans, attempting to protect as much of its investment as possible. Management evaluates the circumstances surrounding each modification to determine whether it is a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”). TDRs exist when 1) the restructuring constitutes a concession, and 2) the debtor is experiencing financial difficulties. Additional information regarding the Company’s troubled debt restructurings can be found in Note 3 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

At December 31, 2014, the Company had a recorded balance of $22,881 in goodwill from the November 30, 2005, acquisition of Northwest Business Financial Corporation (“NWBF”) and the February 1, 2013, acquisition of Century Bank. In addition, at December 31, 2014, the Company had $614 of core deposit intangible assets resulting from the acquisition of Century Bank. The Century Bank core deposit intangible was determined to have an expected life of seven years, and is being amortized over that period using the straight-line method. The Century Bank core deposit intangible will be fully amortized in January 2020. In accordance with GAAP, the Company does not amortize goodwill or other intangible assets with indefinite lives but instead periodically tests these assets for impairment. Management performs an impairment analysis of the intangible assets with indefinite lives at least annually, but more frequently if an impairment triggering event is deemed to have occurred. The last impairment test was performed at December 31, 2014, at which time no impairment was determined to exist.

Share-based Compensation

Consistent with the provisions of FASB ASC 718, Stock Compensation, a revision to the previously issued guidance on accounting for stock options and other forms of equity-based compensation, we recognize expense for the grant-date fair value of stock options and other equity-based forms of compensation issued to employees over the employees’ requisite service period (generally the vesting period). The requisite service period may be subject to performance conditions. The fair value of each option grant is estimated as of the grant date using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. Management assumptions utilized at the time of grant impact the fair value of the option calculated under the Black-Scholes methodology, and ultimately, the expense that will be recognized over the service period of the option. Additional information is included in Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K.

Fair Value Measurements

Generally accepted accounting principles define fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. FASB ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements, establishes a three-level hierarchy for disclosure of assets and liabilities recorded at fair value. The classification of assets and liabilities within the hierarchy is based on whether the inputs to the valuation methodology used for measurement are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect market-derived or market-based information obtained from independent sources while unobservable inputs reflect our estimates about market data. In general, fair values determined by Level 1 inputs utilize quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets that the Company has the

 

41


Table of Contents

ability to access. Fair values determined by Level 2 inputs utilize inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. Level 2 inputs include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets and inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability, such as interest rates and yield curves that are observable at commonly quoted intervals. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability and include situations where there is little, if any, market activity for the asset or liability. In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In such cases, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement in its entirety falls has been determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety. The Company’s assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment, and considers factors specific to the asset or liability.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Recent accounting pronouncements are discussed in Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K. None of these pronouncements are expected to have a significant effect on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

Net Interest Income

The largest component of the Company’s earnings is net interest income. Net interest income is the difference between interest income derived from earning assets, principally loans, and the interest expense associated with interest-bearing liabilities, principally deposits. The volume and mix of earning assets and funding sources, market rates of interest, demand for loans, and the availability of deposits affect net interest income.

Two tables follow which analyze the changes in net interest income for the years 2014, 2013 and 2012. Table I, “Average Balance Analysis of Net Interest Income,” provides information with regard to average balances of assets and liabilities as well as associated dollar amounts of interest income and interest expense, relevant average yields or rates, and net interest income as a percent of average earning assets. Net interest income and the net interest margin for all periods reported have been adjusted to a tax-equivalent basis using a 35.00% tax rate. Table II, “Analysis of Changes in Interest Income and Interest Expense,” shows the increase (decrease) in the dollar amount of interest income and interest expense and the differences attributable to changes in either volume or rates.

2014 Compared to 2013

The net interest margin for the year 2014 was 4.30%, a decline of 6 basis points from the 4.36% net interest margin reported for 2013. Included in the noninterest income for both years were nonrecurring payments. In 2014 the bank recognized $814 of nonrecurring interest income comprised of $527 of Century Bank accretion, $187 of prepayment penalties, and $100 of interest of interest income on loans previously on nonaccrual status. The 2013 net interest margin included $2,115 of nonrecurring items consisting of $913 of Century Bank accretion, $982 of interest income on loans previously on nonaccrual status and $220 of prepayment penalties.

 

42


Table of Contents

To better understand the Bank’s core interest margin we have provided the following non-GAAP financial metric, which removes the nonrecurring interest income and the accretion of the Century Bank loan discounts. Management utilizes certain non-GAAP financial measures to monitor the Company’s performance. While we believe the presentation of non-GAAP financial measures provides additional insight into our operating performance, readers of this report are urged to review the GAAP results as presented in the Financial Statements and Supplementary Data in this Form 10-K.

Reconciliation of Adjusted Net Interest Income to Net Interest Income

 

     December 31,  
     2014     2013  

Tax equivalent net interest income (1)

   $ 58,509      $ 57,172   

Subtract

    

Century Bank accretion

     527        913   

Interest recoveries on nonaccrual loans

     100        982   

Prepayment penalties

     187        220   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net interest income (non-GAAP)

$ 57,695    $ 55,057   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average earnings Assets

$ 1,362,157    $ 1,312,660   

Net Interest Margin

  4.30   4.36

Core net interest margin (non-GAAP)

  4.24   4.19

 

(1) Tax-exempt income has been adjusted to a tax-equivalent basis at a 35% tax rate. The amount of such adjustment was an addition to recorded income of $1,061 and $1,033 for the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, and 2013, respectively.

These nonrecurring items added 6 and 17 basis points to the 2014 and 2013 net interest margins, respectively. When comparing non-GAAP core interest margin, we saw an improvement of 5 basis points from 4.19% in 2013 to 4.24% in 2014.

Table I shows earning asset yields declined by 9 basis points from 4.72% in 2013 to 4.63% in 2014. The yield on loans dropped 32 basis points from 2013 to 2014, which was partially offset by a 31 basis point improvement in the yield on the taxable portion of the securities portfolio over the same period. The 2014 net interest margin benefitted from a decline in the cost of interest-bearing liabilities and an increase in free funding over the prior year. The cost of interest-bearing liabilities fell 3 basis points from 0.53% in 2013 to 0.50% in 2014. In addition, free funding in the form of average noninterest bearing deposits increased $40,112 or 11.94% in 2014 over 2013. The decline in the cost of interest-bearing liabilities from 2013 to 2014 was due to a decrease in the cost interest-bearing core deposits of 5 basis points, which was partially offset by an increase in the cost of interest-bearing wholesale funding of 10 basis points.

The year ended December 31, 2014, rate/volume analysis in Table II shows that interest income including loan fees increased by $1,122 over 2013. Higher volume, specifically higher loan volume, resulted in an increase of $3,479 in interest income in 2014, which was partially offset by a $2,357 decline in interest income due to lower rates on loans. The rate/volume analysis shows that interest expense for the year 2014 decreased by $215 from 2013 with interest expense on core deposits declining by $263 while wholesale funding expense increased by $48. Overall, changes in the volume mix decreased interest expense by $173 in 2014, while lower rates on interest-bearing liabilities decreased interest expense by $42.

The year ended December 31, 2013, rate/volume analysis in Table II shows that interest income including loan fees increased by $5,197 over 2012. Higher volume, specifically higher loan volume, resulted in an increase of $7,364 in interest income, which was partially offset by a $2,167 decline in interest income due to lower rates on loans. The rate/volume analysis shows that interest expense for the year 2013 decreased by $1,024 from 2012 with interest expense on core deposits and wholesale funding declining by $590 and $434, respectively. Overall, higher volumes or changes in volume mix increased interest expense by $626, while lower rates on interest-bearing liabilities decreased interest expense by $1,650.

 

43


Table of Contents

2013 Compared to 2012

The net interest margin for the year 2013 was 4.36%, an improvement of 13 basis points over the 4.23% net interest margin reported for 2012. Most of the improvement in the 2013 net interest margin over the prior year was due to a lower cost of funds as earning asset yields were relatively stable. Table I shows that earning asset yields improved by 1 basis point to 4.72% in 2013 from 4.71% in 2012. However, the yield on earning assets was positively affected in 2013 by two nonrecurring items: 1) collection of $982 of interest income on loans previously on nonaccrual status during third quarter 2013; and 2) $220 in interest income due to a prepayment penalty collected on an early loan pay off during fourth quarter 2013. These two nonrecurring items added 10 basis points to the 2013 net interest margin. In addition, the Company recorded $913 in interest income during 2013 in accretion of the fair value loan marks related to the Century Bank transaction, which added another 7 basis points to the 2013 net interest margin. Excluding the nonrecurring items and accretion of loan fair value marks, the core net interest margin for 2013 was 4.19%, or a decline of 4 basis points from the prior year.

While earning asset yields remained relatively stable, the cost of interest-bearing liabilities in 2013 dropped 17 basis points from 0.70% in 2012 to 0.53% in 2013. Much of the decline was attributable to the cost of interest-bearing core deposits, which were down 13 basis points in 2013 from 2012 levels. In addition, all categories of interest-bearing wholesale funding showed declines in 2013 from the previous year with the exception of the rate paid on trust preferred securities, which increased from 1.83% in 2012 to 2.42% in 2013. During April 2013, the Company entered into a swap agreement with a third party, which fixed the rate on its $8,000 of trust preferred securities at 2.73% for seven years. Prior to the swap agreement, the Company paid a variable rate on its trust preferred securities based on three-month LIBOR plus 135 basis points. In addition to a lower cost of interest-bearing liabilities, the Company’s net interest margin benefitted from free funding in the form of average non-interest bearing demand deposits for the year 2013, which increased $38,635, or 12.99%, over the prior year.

 

44


Table of Contents

Table I

Average Balance Analysis of Net Interest Income

(dollars in thousands)

 

     Twelve Months Ended
December 31, 2014
    Twelve Months Ended
December 31, 2013
    Twelve Months Ended
December 31, 2012
 
     Average
Balance
     Interest
Income or
(Expense)
    Average
Yields or
Rates
    Average
Balance
     Interest
Income or
(Expense)
    Average
Yields or
Rates
    Average
Balance
     Interest
Income or
(Expense)
    Average
Yields or
Rates
 

Interest-earning assets

                     

Federal funds sold and interest-bearing deposits

   $ 3,926       $ 10        0.25   $ 3,390       $ 10        0.29   $ 2,823       $ 6        0.21

Securities available-for-sale:

                     

Taxable

     276,625         6,191        2.24     296,574         5,730        1.93     326,159         6,171        1.89

Tax-exempt (1)

     71,424         3,032        4.25     69,315         2,951        4.26     58,651         2,500        4.26

Loans held-for-sale

     —           —          0.00     —           —          0.00     190         7        0.00

Loans, net of deferred fees and allowance (2)

     1,010,182         53,855        5.33     943,381         53,275        5.65     816,465         48,085        5.89
  

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

    

 

 

   

Total interest-earning assets (1)

     1,362,157         63,088        4.63     1,312,660         61,966        4.72     1,204,288         56,769        4.71

Non earning assets

                     

Cash and due from banks

     18,506             18,607             17,678        

Premises and equipment

     18,324             19,223             19,710        

Goodwill & intangible assets

     23,556             23,579             22,126        

Interest receivable and other

     54,517             59,144             53,292        
  

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total nonearning assets

     114,903             120,553             112,806        
  

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total assets

   $ 1,477,060           $ 1,433,213           $ 1,317,094        
  

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

      

Interest-bearing liabilities

                     

Money market and NOW accounts

   $ 543,116       $ (1,491     -0.27   $ 518,031       $ (1,586     -0.31   $ 483,110       $ (2,011     -0.42

Savings deposits

     51,164         (67     -0.13     41,930         (52     -0.12     37,994         (59     -0.16

Time deposits—core

     60,685         (326     -0.54     71,568         (509     -0.71     58,724         (667     -1.14
  

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

    

 

 

   

Total interest-bearing core deposits (3)

     654,965         (1,884     -0.29     631,529         (2,147     -0.34     579,828         (2,737     -0.47

Time deposits—non-core

     101,288         (1,368     -1.35     106,574         (1,242     -1.17     95,598         (1,322     -1.38

Federal funds purchased

     2,053         (14     -0.68     3,369         (16     -0.47     4,497         (24     -0.53

FHLB & FRB borrowings

     146,464         (1,088     -0.74     162,302         (1,189     -0.73     145,509         (1,584     -1.09

Trust preferred

     8,248         (225     -2.73     8,248         (200     -2.42     8,248         (151     -1.83
  

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

    

 

 

   

Total interest-bearing wholesale funding

     258,053         (2,695     -1.04     280,493         (2,647     -0.94     253,852         (3,081     -1.21
  

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

    

 

 

   

Total interest-bearing liabilities

     913,018         (4,579     -0.50     912,022         (4,794     -0.53     833,680         (5,818     -0.70

Noninterest-bearing liabilities

                     

Demand deposits

     376,175             336,063             297,428        

Interest payable and other

     6,105             4,271             4,511        
  

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total noninterest liabilities

     382,280             340,334             301,939        
  

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total liabilities

     1,295,298             1,252,356             1,135,619        

Shareholders’ equity

     181,762             180,857             181,475        
  

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

   $ 1,477,060           $ 1,433,213           $ 1,317,094        
  

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

      

Net interest income

      $ 58,509           $ 57,172           $ 50,951     
     

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

   

Net interest margin (1)

        4.30          4.36          4.23  
     

 

 

        

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

(1) Tax-exempt income has been adjusted to a tax-equivalent basis at a 35% tax rate. The amount of such adjustment was an addition to recorded income of approximately $1,061, $1,033, and $875 for the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. Net interest margin was positively impacted by 8, 8, and 7 basis points, respectively.
(2) Interest income includes recognized loan origination fees of $574, $523, and $243 for the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively.
(3) Defined by the Company as interest checking, money market, savings and local non-public time deposits, including local non-public time deposits in excess of $100.

 

45


Table of Contents

Table II

Analysis of Changes in Interest Income and Interest Expense

(dollars in thousands)

 

     2014 compared to 2013 Increase
(decrease) due to
    2013 compared to 2012 Increase
(decrease) due to
 
     Volume     Rate     Net     Volume     Rate     Net  

Interest earned on:

            

Federal funds sold and interest-bearing deposits

   $ 2      $ (2   $ —        $ 1      $ 3      $ 4   

Securities available-for-sale:

            

Taxable

     (385     846        461        (560     119        (441

Tax-exempt (1)

     90        (9     81        455        (4     451   

Loans held-for-sale

     —          —          —          (7     —          (7

Loans, net of deferred fees and allowance

     3,772        (3,192     580        7,475        (2,285     5,190   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest-earning assets (1)

  3,479      (2,357   1,122      7,364      (2,167   5,197   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest paid on:

Money market and NOW accounts

  77      (172   (95   145      (570   (425

Savings deposits

  11      4      15      6      (13   (7

Time deposits—core (2)

  (77   (106   (183   146      (304   (158
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing core deposits

  11      (274   (263   297      (887   (590

Time deposits—non-core

  (62   188      126      152      (232   (80

Federal funds purchased

  (6   4      (2   (6   (2   (8

FHLB & FRB borrowings

  (116   15      (101   183      (578   (395

Trust preferred

  —        25      25      —        49      49   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing wholesale funding

  (184   232      48      329      (763   (434
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

  (173   (42   (215   626      (1,650   (1,024
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (1)

$ 3,652    $ (2,315 $ 1,337    $ 6,738    $ (517 $ 6,221   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Tax-exempt income has been adjusted to a tax-equivalent basis at a 35% tax rate. The amount of such adjustment was an addition to recorded income of approximately $1,061, $1,033 and $875 for the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively.
(2) Defined by the Company as interest checking, money market, savings and local non-public time deposits, including local non-public time deposits in excess of $100.

Provision for Loan Losses

Management provides for possible loan losses by maintaining an allowance. The level of the allowance is determined based upon judgments regarding the size and nature of the loan portfolio, historical loss experience, the financial condition of borrowers, the level of nonperforming loans, and current general economic conditions. Additions to the allowance are charged to expense. Loans are charged against the allowance when management believes the collection of principal is unlikely.

The Company made no provision for loan losses in 2014 compared to a provision of $250 for 2013. The decrease in the 2014 provision was due to reductions in levels of net charge offs, classified assets and nonperforming loans. Net loan charge offs for the year 2014 ended were $280 or 0.03% of average outstanding loans compared to $678 or 0.07% of average outstanding loans in 2013. Classified assets at December 31, 2014, were $44,298, down $7,751 from classified assets of $52,050 at December 31, 2013. Classified assets as a percentage of regulatory capital at December 31, 2014, were 24.54%, compared to 29.01% at December 31, 2013. Nonperforming assets, net of government guaranteed loans, at December 31, 2014, were $15,363, down $5,600 from nonperforming assets, net of government guaranteed loans, of $20,963 at December 31, 2013.

 

46


Table of Contents

The provision for loan losses was $250 in 2013 compared to $1,900 for the year 2012. The decrease in the 2013 provision for loan losses when compared to 2012 was due to reductions in the levels of classified and nonperforming assets and recoveries booked during the year. Net charge offs for the year ended 2013 were $678 or 0.07% of average loans compared to $496 of net charge offs or 0.06% of average loans in 2012. Classified assets at December 31, 2013, were $52,050, down $4,033 from classified assets of $56,082 at December 31, 2012. Classified assets as a percentage of regulatory capital were 29.02% at December 31, 2013, compared to 31.18% at December 31, 2012. Nonperforming assets, net of government guaranteed loans, at December 31, 2013, were $20,963, down $5,465 from the prior year-end.

Nonperforming Assets

At December 31, 2014, the Company had $15,363 in nonperforming assets, net of government guarantees, or 1.02% of total assets, compared to $20,963 or 1.45% of total assets at December 31, 2013. The schedule below provides a more detailed breakdown of nonperforming assets by loan type:

NONPERFORMING ASSETS

 

     December 31,  
     2014     2013  

Nonaccrual loans

    

Real estate secured loans:

    

Permanent loans:

    

Multi-family residential

   $ —        $ —     

Residential 1-4 family

     321        636   

Owner-occupied commercial

     599        1,685   

Nonowner-occupied commercial

     906        136   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total permanent real estate loans

  1,826      2,457   

Construction loans:

Multi-family residential

  —        —     

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —     

Commercial real estate

  —        —     

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —     

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total real estate construction loans

  —        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  1,826      2,457   

Commercial loans

  869      2,886   

Consumer loans

  —        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonaccrual loans

  2,695      5,343   

90 days past due and accruing interest

  —        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonperforming loans

  2,695      5,343   

Nonperforming loans guaranteed by government

  (706   (735
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net nonperforming loans

  1,989      4,608   

Other real estate owned

  13,374      16,355   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonperforming assets, net of guaranteed loans

$ 15,363    $ 20,963   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Nonperforming loans to outstanding loans

  0.19   0.46

Nonperforming assets to total assets

  1.02   1.45

Nonperforming assets at December 31, 2014, consisted of $1,989 of nonaccrual loans (net of $706 in government guarantees) and $13,374 of other real estate owned. Total nonperforming assets at December 31, 2014, were down $5,600 from nonperforming assets at December 31, 2013, as the Company resolved problem loans and disposed of other real estate owned. At December 31, 2014, dental nonperforming assets totaled $597, down $1,803 from the $2,400 reported at December 31, 2013. Other real estate owned at December 31, 2014, consisted of eight properties. Two properties, a commercial land development loan, which contains two separate parcels, and a commercial real estate property, valued at $10,040 and $1,244, respectively, made up 84.37% of total other real estate owned at such date. While the Company is actively marketing both properties, the location and type of these two properties make them susceptible to possible valuation write-downs as new appraisals become available.

 

47


Table of Contents

The allowance for loan losses at December 31, 2014, was $15,637 (1.50% of gross outstanding loans) compared to $15,917 (1.60% of loans) and $16,345 (1.88% of loans) at the years ended 2013 and 2012, respectively. The reduction in the allowance for loan losses to total loans ratio in 2013 compared to 2012 was primarily due to loans acquired in the Century Bank transaction, which were booked net of fair value adjustments, including the fair value adjustment for credit and potential losses. At December 31, 2014, the Company had also reserved $227 for possible losses on unfunded loan commitments, which was classified in other liabilities. The 2014 ending allowance included $245 in specific allowance for $6,856 in impaired loans (net of government guarantees). At December 31, 2013, the Company had $8,476 in impaired loans with a specific allowance of $57 assigned.

The dental allowance for loan losses at December 31, 2014, was $4,187 or 1.37% of dental loans. This is an increase from the $3,730 or 1.21% of dental loans at December 31, 2013. Management has raised the allowance as a percentage of outstanding loans over the prior year due to the increase in national dental lending. To date, the national dental portfolio has demonstrated similar performance to the local dental portfolio; however the portfolio is newer in age and, therefore, may incur losses over time. For additional information on the dental portfolio statistics, please see Note 4 of the Consolidated Financial Statement in this Form 10-K.

While the Company saw some positive trends in 2014 with its resolution of classified assets and nonperforming assets, management cannot predict with certainty the level of the provision for loan losses, the level of the allowance for loans losses, nor the level of nonperforming assets in future quarters. At December 31, 2014, and as shown in this Form 10-K under Note 3 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, the Company’s unallocated reserves were $1,279 of the total allowance for loan losses, at year-end 2014. Management believes that the allowance for loan losses at December 31, 2014, is adequate and this level of unallocated reserves was prudent in light of the economic conditions that exist in the Northwest markets the Company serves.

Noninterest Income

Noninterest income is derived from sources other than fees and interest on earning assets. The Company’s primary sources of noninterest income are service charge fees on deposit accounts, merchant bankcard activity, and business credit card interchange fees.

2014 Compared to 2013

Noninterest income for the year 2014 was $4,995, down $831 or 14.26% from the same period last year. The decline in noninterest income in 2014 when compared to the prior year was due to a decline in merchant bankcard processing fees and the other income category. Merchant bankcard processing was outsourced during fourth quarter 2013 and resulted in a $673 drop in merchant fees in 2014. This outsourcing also resulted in the near elimination of bankcard processing expense. The decline in the other revenue category was related to a decrease in rental income on other real estate owned, as during the first quarter 2014, the Company sold a retail strip mall that provided the majority of rental income during 2013. Improved service charge revenue of $208 partially offset the decline in merchant fees. The improvement in service charge revenue was the result of implementing new account analysis charges effective January 1, 2014.

2013 Compared to 2012

Noninterest income for the year 2013 was $5,826, an increase of $85 or 1.48% over 2012. Increases in service charges on deposit accounts, other fee income, principally bankcard, and the other noninterest income category were partially offset by declines in mortgage banking income and bank-owned-life-insurance (“BOLI”) revenue. The increase in other fee income, principally bankcard, was due to higher sales transaction volume in merchant bankcard. The increase in the other income category of noninterest income was primarily due to the outsourcing of the Company’s merchant bankcard processing portfolio in December 2013, which resulted in upfront income of $124. The decline in mortgage banking income was due to the closure of this division of the Company following first quarter 2012. BOLI revenue declined due to a lower return on investments, resulting in a slightly lower yield on the BOLI investment. In addition, contributing to the low growth in noninterest revenue was $23 in other-than-temporary-impairment charge related to two private-label mortgage-backed securities.

 

48


Table of Contents

Noninterest Expense

Noninterest expense represents all expenses other than the provision for loan losses and interest costs associated with deposits and other interest-bearing liabilities. It incorporates personnel, premises and equipment, data processing and other operating expenses.

 

49


Table of Contents

2014 Compared to 2013

For the year 2014, noninterest expense was $37,729, a decrease of $3,003 or 7.37% from the same period last year. When merger expenses of $470 recorded in 2014 relating to the acquisition of Capital Pacific Bank and $1,246 recorded in 2013 relating to the Century Bank acquisition are excluded from 2013, noninterest expense for the year 2014 was down $2,227 or 5.64% from last year. A $1,435 or 6.49% increase in personnel expense in 2014 was offset by declines in legal and professional fees of $615, business development costs of $274, other real estate expense of $1,952, bankcard processing expense of $520, and the other expense category of $423. The decline in legal and professional fees was due to the recovery of $300 of legal fees expensed in prior periods recorded during the third quarter 2014. The decline in business development costs reflects a more focused marketing strategy during 2014 at a lower cost than 2013. The significant decline in other real estate expense was the result of large valuation write-downs totaling approximately $1,100 recorded during 2013 on two commercial properties. No significant valuation write-downs were recorded during 2014. The decline in bankcard processing expense was the result of outsourcing this service during the fourth quarter 2013, which virtually eliminated these costs during 2014. The decline in the other expense category was primarily due to lower travel costs and non-recurring expense of $100 recorded in 2013.

At the June 2014 board meeting, the Company’s board of directors approved a deferred compensation plan. The plan is a qualified unfunded plan, which contains no employer defined contribution or benefit. This plan is open to Senior Vice Presidents and above, and the board of directors. Deferrals began during August 2014, and 2014 deferred compensation expense totaled $45 which is reflected in the salaries and employee benefits line item of the income statement.

2013 Compared to 2012

For the year 2013, noninterest expense was $40,732, up $5,627 or 16.03% over 2012. The year 2013 noninterest expense included $1,246 of merger expense related to the acquisition of Century Bank compared to merger expense of $203 in 2012. Excluding merger expense in both 2013 and 2012, noninterest expense increased $4,584 or 13.13% in 2013 over 2012. All categories of non-merger related noninterest expense, with the exception of FDIC assessments and bankcard processing, were up in 2013 when compared to 2012. The most significant increases in noninterest expense were in salaries and employee benefits, data processing, business development, and other real estate expense. Salaries and employee benefits were up $2,544 or 13.00%, primarily attributable to the full year impact of relationship bankers added to staff during 2012 and additional relationship bankers added during 2013, including relationship bankers included in the acquisition of Century Bank. Data processing expense in 2013 was up $509 or 24.28% due to an increase in software maintenance expense, which is assessed by various third parties based on asset size of the institution. Business development expense was up $247 or 15.85% as the Company increased marketing and sales efforts in all of its primary markets, including the national healthcare lending market. Other real estate expense for the year 2013 increased $907 or 60.71%, primarily due to valuation write downs on two properties.

BALANCE SHEET

Securities Available-for-Sale

At December 31, 2014, the balance of securities available-for-sale was $351,946, up $4,560 over December 31, 2013. The increase in the securities portfolio during the year was entirely due to improvement in the unrealized gain on the portfolio. At December 31, 2014, the portfolio had an unrealized pre-tax gain of $6,057 compared to an unrealized pre-tax loss of $242, at December 31, 2013. The improvement in the unrealized gain or market value of the securities portfolio during 2014 was due to a decline in longer-term interest rates and tightening of spreads on virtually all investment products. The average life and duration of the portfolio at December 31, 2014, was 3.9 years and 3.6 respectively, down from 4.2 years and 3.8 at December 31, 2013. At December 31, 2014, $27,246 of the securities portfolio were pledged as collateral for public deposits in Oregon and Washington and for repurchase agreements.

The Company continued to structure the portfolio to provide consistent cash flow and reduce the market value volatility of the portfolio in a rising rate environment in light of the Company’s current liability sensitive position. The portfolio is structured to generate sufficient cash flow to allow reinvestment at higher rates should interest rates move up or to fund loan growth in future periods. In a stable rate environment, approximately $58,700 in cash flow is anticipated over the next twelve months. Going forward, purchases will be dependent upon core deposit growth, loan growth, and the Company’s interest rate risk position.

 

50


Table of Contents

At December 31, 2014, $3,816, or 1.08% of the total securities portfolio was composed of private-label mortgage-backed securities. In previous reporting periods management has booked OTTI on this portion of the portfolio totaling approximately $227. During the second quarter 2014, a classified private-label mortgage-backed security was sold at a loss of $97. The loss in the second quarter 2014 more than offset the gain on sale of securities of $63 recorded during first quarter 2014. It was determined that an OTTI was required on this security. After further analysis, it was also determined that future impairment was possible and additional losses could result in future additional impairment charges. The sale at the loss limited the potential future losses.

Management reviews monthly all available information, including current and projected default rates and current and projected loss severities, related to the collectability of its potentially impaired investment securities to determine if an additional OTTI is required. No additional OTTI was recorded during 2014. Recognition of additional OTTI on the private-label mortgage-backed portion of the portfolio is possible in future quarters depending upon economic conditions, default rates on home mortgages, loss severities on foreclosed homes, unemployment levels, and home values.

In management’s opinion, the remaining securities in the portfolio in an unrealized loss position are considered only temporarily impaired. The Company has no intent, nor is it more likely than not that it will be required, to sell its impaired securities before their recovery. The impairment is due to changes in market interest rates or the widening of market spreads subsequent to the initial purchase of the securities, and not due to concerns regarding the underlying credit of the issuers or the underlying collateral. The decline in value of these securities resulted from current economic conditions. Although yields on these securities may be below market rates during the period, no loss of principal is expected.

Loans

At December 31, 2014, outstanding gross loans were $1,046,011, up $51,242 over outstanding loans of $994,769 at December 31, 2013. A summary of outstanding loans by market, including national health care loans, for the years ended December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, follows:

 

                   2014 vs. 2013  
Loans    December 31,      $ Increase      % Increase  
     2014      2013      (Decrease)      (Decrease)  

Eugene market gross loans, period-end

   $ 363,953       $ 334,511       $ 29,442         8.80

Portland market gross loans, period-end

     407,466         391,295         16,171         4.13

Seattle market gross loans, period-end

     119,095         132,488         (13,393      -10.11

National health care gross loans, period end

     155,497         136,475         19,022         13.94
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total gross loans, period-end

$ 1,046,011    $ 994,769    $ 51,242      5.15
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

During 2014, all of the Company’s markets, with the exception of Seattle, showed growth in outstanding loans over the prior year. Loan growth was strongest in the Eugene market, followed by national healthcare lending, then the Portland market. Growth in the Eugene and Portland markets resulted from improved economic conditions and greater market demand for loans. The majority of growth in these two markets was in commercial and owner-occupied commercial real estate loans. Growth in National healthcare loans accounted for $19,022 of the organic loan growth recorded during 2014. The Company now has national healthcare loans in 35 states. The Company defines National healthcare loans as loans to healthcare professionals, primarily dentists located outside of the Company’s primary market area. The Company’s defined market area is within the states of Oregon and Washington west of the Cascade Mountain Range. This area is serviced by branch locations in Eugene, Oregon; Portland, Oregon; and Seattle, Washington. National health care loans, loans east of the Cascade Mountain Range and outside Oregon and Washington, are maintained and serviced by personnel located in the Portland market. The contraction in the Seattle market was attributable to significant early loan pay offs during the year. Early pay offs in the Seattle market were related to a variety of factors, including completion of construction projects, aggressive pricing on healthcare loans, and unwillingness to renew loans to existing clients based on credit concerns.

Outstanding loans to dental professionals, which are comprised of both local and national loans, at December 31, 2014, totaled $306,391 or 29.29% of the loan portfolio. This was virtually unchanged from total dental loans of $307,268, or 30.89% of the loan portfolio, at December 31, 2013. Growth in national loans of $18,371 was more than offset by a $19,248 contraction in the local market dental loans. The more seasoned local dental loan portfolio experienced higher prepayment speeds primarily due to competitive refinancing pricing offered, which was particularly present in the Seattle market. In addition, given the credit quality of dental loans in general, the Company encountered very competitive pricing in the national market. At

 

51


Table of Contents

December 31, 2014, $12,700 or 4.15%, of the outstanding dental loans were supported by government guarantees. Loans to dental professionals include loans for such purposes as starting up a practice, acquisition of a practice, equipment financing, owner-occupied facilities, and working capital. National dental loans are limited to acquisition financing and owner-occupied facilities. Additional data on the Company’s dental loan portfolio and the credit quality of this portfolio can be found in Note 4 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this report. Additional information regarding loan concentrations is included in Part II, Item 1A “Risk Factors” of this report under the heading “Loan concentrations within one industry may create additional risk, and we have a significant concentration in loans to dental professionals.”

Detailed credit quality data on the entire loan portfolio can be found in Note 3 and Note 4 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this report.

Goodwill

At December 31, 2014, the Company had a recorded balance of $22,881 in goodwill from the November 30, 2005, acquisition of NWB Financial Corporation and its wholly owned subsidiary, Northwest Business Bank (“NWBF”) and the February 1, 2013 acquisition of Century Bank. In accordance with GAAP, the Company does not amortize goodwill or other intangible assets with indefinite lives, but instead periodically tests these assets for impairment. Management performed an impairment analysis at December 31, 2014, and determined there was no impairment of the goodwill at the time of the analysis.

Deferred Tax Assets

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax credit carry forwards. At December 31, 2014, the Company had a net deferred tax asset of $4,464. Deferred tax assets are reviewed for recoverability and valuation allowances are provided, when necessary, to reduce deferred tax assets to the amounts expected to be realized. A valuation allowance is provided for deferred tax assets if it is more likely than not these items will either expire before the Company is able to realize their benefit, or that future deductibility is uncertain. In light of the Company’s performance, management anticipates that the deferred tax assets will be fully utilized to offset future income taxes and that no valuation allowance is required. Additional disclosures regarding the components of the net deferred tax asset are included in Note 13 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K.

Deposits

Outstanding deposits at December 31, 2014, were $1,209,093, an increase of $118,112 over outstanding deposits of $1,090,981 at December 31, 2013. Core deposits, which are defined by the Company as demand, interest checking, money market, savings, and local non-public time deposits, including local non-public time deposits in excess of $100, were $1,110,861, up $120,546 or 12.17% over outstanding core deposits of $990,315 at December 31, 2013. At December 31, 2014, and 2013, core deposits represented 91.88% and 90.77%, respectively, of total deposits. Year-to-date December 31, 2014, average core deposits, a measurement that removes daily volatility, were $1,031,140, an increase of $63,548 or 6.57% over average core deposits of $967,592 for the year 2013.

 

52


Table of Contents

A summary of outstanding deposits by market for the years 2014 and 2013 follows:

 

                   2014 vs. 2013  
     December 31,      $ Increase      % Increase  
     2014      2013      (Decrease)      (Decrease)  

Eugene market core deposits, period-end

   $ 672,527       $ 588,158       $ 84,369         14.34

Portland market core deposits, period-end

     276,453         249,050         27,403         11.00

Seattle market core deposits, period-end

     161,881         153,107         8,774         5.73
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total core deposits, period-end

  1,110,861      990,315      120,546      12.17

Public and brokered deposits, period-end

  98,232      100,666      (2,434   -2.42
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total deposits, period-end

$ 1,209,093    $ 1,090,981    $ 118,112      10.83
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

All markets showed an increase in core deposits during 2014, with both the Eugene and Portland markets showing double digit percentage growth. All three of the Company’s markets successfully acquired new deposit relationships and deepened deposit relationships with existing clients. Because of its strategic focus on business banking and banking for nonprofits, the Company attracts a number of large depositors that account for a relatively significant portion of the core deposit base. The Company continued to be successful in deepening deposit relationships with existing large depositors in 2014 and also attracting new large depositor relationships. Large depositor balances are subject to significant daily volatility. At December 31, 2014, large depositors, generally defined as relationships with $1,000 or more in deposits, accounted for $490,159 of the Company’s total core deposit base and represented 44.12% of outstanding core deposits, compared to $369,718 or 37.33% of outstanding core deposits at December 31, 2013. For more information on the Company’s large depositors and management of these relationships, see the “Liquidity and Cash Flows” Section of Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations in this Form 10-K. Additional information on deposits may also be found in Note 8 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-K.

Public and Brokered Deposits

The Company uses public and brokered deposits to provide short-term and long-term funding sources. The Company defines short-term as having a contractual maturity of less than one year. The Company uses brokered deposits to help mitigate interest rate risk in a rising rate environment. All long-term brokered deposits have a call feature, which provides the Company the option to redeem the deposits on a quarterly basis, allowing the Company to refinance long-term funding at lower rates should market rates fall. Below is a schedule detailing public and brokered deposits by type, including weighted average rate (“WAR”) and weighted average maturity (“WAM”).

Non-Core Deposit Summary

 

     December 31, 2014  
     Balance      WAR     WAM  

Short-Term Public Time Deposits

   $ 44,519         0.19     44 days   

Long-Term Public Time Deposits

     495         0.01     6.32 years   
  

 

 

      
$ 45,014   

Short-Term Brokered Time Deposits

$ 10,000      0.25   156 days   

Long-Term Brokered Time Deposits

  43,218      2.12   6.15 years   
  

 

 

      
$ 53,218   

Borrowings

The Company has both secured and unsecured borrowing lines with the Federal Home Loan Bank, Federal Reserve Bank and various correspondent Banks. The Federal Reserve and correspondent borrowings are generally short-term, with a maturity of less than 30 days. The Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings can be either short-term or long-term in nature. See Note 10 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in item 8 of this report for a full maturity and interest rate schedule for the Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings.

 

53


Table of Contents

Junior Subordinated Debentures

The Company had $8,248 in junior subordinated debentures outstanding at December 31, 2014, which were issued in conjunction with the 2005 acquisition of NWBF. The junior subordinated debentures had an interest rate of 6.27% that was fixed through January 2011. In January 2011, the rate on the junior subordinated debentures changed to three-month LIBOR plus 135 basis points. On April 22, 2013, the Bank entered into a cash flow hedge on $8,000 of the trust preferred payment, swapping the variable interest rate for a fixed rate of 2.73% for a seven-year period. At December 31, 2014, the fair value of the interest rate swap on the Company’s subordinated debentures was $176. At December 31, 2014, the $8,000 of the junior subordinated debentures qualified as Tier 1 capital under regulatory capital guidelines.

In July 2010, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (“Dodd-Frank Act”) was signed into law which, among other things, limits the ability of certain bank holding companies to treat trust preferred security debt issuances, such as the Company’s junior subordinated debentures, as Tier 1 capital. Under final rules, recently adopted by the Federal Reserve Board and the other U.S. federal banking agencies, our trust preferred securities would remain as Tier 1 capital since total assets of the Company are less than $15 billion. Additional information regarding these final capital rules is included in in Part I, Item 1A “Risk Factors” of the report under the heading “We operate in a highly regulated environment and the effects of recent and pending federal legislation or of changes in, or supervisory enforcement of, banking or other laws and regulations could adversely affect us.”

Additional information regarding the terms of the cash flow hedge is included in Note 12 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in item 8 of this report.

CAPITAL RESOURCES

Capital is the shareholders’ investment in the Company. Capital grows through the retention of earnings and the issuance of new stock or other equity securities whether through stock offerings or through the exercise of equity awards. Capital formation allows the Company to grow assets and provides flexibility in times of adversity. Shareholders’ equity at December 31, 2014, was $184,161, up $4,977 from December 31, 2013. The increase in shareholders’ equity was primarily due to the improvement in the market value of the Company’s securities available-for-sale, which positively impacted accumulated other comprehensive income.

On May 6, 2014, the Company’s Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of up to 5.00% of the Company’s outstanding shares, or 892,500 shares, with the purchases to take place over a 12-month period. During 2014, the Company repurchased 267,080 shares at a weighted average price of $13.48 per share. Throughout 2013 and 2014, the Company has used a combination of regular dividends, special dividends, and share repurchases to maintain capital levels comparable with year-end December 31, 2011, capital levels. For additional details regarding the changes in equity, review the Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity in Item 1 of Part I of this report.

The Federal Reserve and the FDIC have in place guidelines for risk-based capital requirements applicable to U.S. bank holding companies and banks. These risk-based capital guidelines take into consideration risk factors, as defined by regulation, associated with various categories of assets, both on and off-balance sheet. Under the guidelines, capital strength is measured in three ways, first by measuring Tier 1 capital to leverage assets, followed by capital measurement in two tiers, which are used in conjunction with risk-adjusted assets to determine the risk-based capital ratios. These guidelines require a minimum of 4.00% Tier 1 capital to leverage assets, 4.00% Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets, and 8.00% total capital to risk-weighted assets. In order to be classified as “well-capitalized,” the highest capital rating by the Federal Reserve and the FDIC, these three ratios must be in excess of 5.00%, 6.00%, and 10.00%, respectively. The Company’s leverage capital ratio, Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio, and Total risk-based capital ratio were 11.33%, 14.48%, and 15.73%, respectively, at December 31, 2014, all capital ratios for the Company and Bank being well above the minimum designations.

In July 2013, the Federal Reserve Board and the other U.S. federal banking agencies adopted final rules making significant changes to the U.S. regulatory capital framework for U.S. banking organizations and to conform this framework to the Basel Committee’s current international regulatory capital accord (Basel III). These rules, upon their effectiveness, will replace the federal banking agencies’ general risk-based capital rules, advanced approaches rule, market-risk rule, and leverage rules, in accordance with certain transition provisions. Banks, such as Pacific Continental Bank, became subject to the new rules on January 1, 2015. The new rules establish more restrictive capital definitions, create additional categories and higher risk-weightings for certain asset classes and off-balance sheet exposures, higher leverage ratios and capital conservation buffers that will be added to the minimum capital requirements and must be met for banking organizations to avoid being

 

54


Table of Contents

subject to certain limitations on dividends and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers. The new rules also implement higher minimum capital requirements, include a new common equity Tier 1 capital requirement, and establish criteria that instruments must meet in order to be considered common equity Tier 1 capital, additional Tier 1 capital, or Tier 2 capital. When fully phased in, the final rules will provide for increased minimum capital ratios as follows: (a) a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 4.50%; (b) a Tier 1 capital ratio of 6.00% (which is an increase from 4.00%); (c) a total capital ratio of 8.00%; and (d) a Tier 1 leverage ratio to average consolidated assets of 4.00%. While earlier proposals would have required that our trust preferred securities (TruPS) be phased out of Tier 1 capital, the new rules exempt depository institution holding companies with less than $15 billion in total consolidated assets as of December 31, 2009, such as the Company, from this requirement. These capital instruments, if issued prior to May 19, 2010, and currently in Tier 1 capital, are grandfathered in Tier 1 capital, subject to certain limits. Under the new rules, in order to avoid limitations on capital distributions, including dividend payments and certain discretionary bonus payments to executive officers, a banking organization must hold a capital conservation buffer composed of common equity Tier 1 capital above its minimum risk-based capital requirements (equal to 2.50% of total risk-weighted assets). The phase-in of the capital conservation buffer will begin January 1, 2016, and be completed by January 1, 2019. The new rules also provide for various adjustments and deductions to the definitions of regulatory capital that will phase in from January 1, 2014, to December 31, 2017. We are currently evaluating the impact of these changes on our regulatory capital.

On January 12, 2014, the Basel Committee issued its near final version of its leverage ratio and disclosure guidance (the “Basel III Leverage Ratio”). The Basel III Leverage Ratio will be subject to further calibration until 2017, with final implementation expected by January 18, 2018. The Basel III Leverage Ratio makes a number of significant changes to the Basel Committee’s June 2013 consultative paper (“Consultative Paper”) by easing the approach to measuring the exposures of off-balance sheet items. These changes address the financial services industry’s concern that the Consultative Paper’s definition of exposure was too expansive, i.e., that the leverage ratio’s denominator was too large. The changes eliminate many, but not all, differences between the Basel III Leverage Ratio and the U.S. supplemental leverage ratio, which is currently set at a minimum of 3.00% and applies to U.S. firms with over $250 billion in assets.

For additional information regarding the Company’s regulatory capital levels, see Note 20 in Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Part I, Item I of this report.

The Company has regularly paid cash dividends on a quarterly basis, typically in February, May, August and November of each year. The Board of Directors considers the dividend amount quarterly and takes a broad perspective in its dividend deliberations including a review of recent operating performance, capital levels, and concentrations of loans as a percentage of capital, and growth projections. The Board also considers dividend payout ratios, dividend yield, and other financial metrics in setting the quarterly dividend. There can be no assurance that dividends will be paid in the future.

During 2014, the Company declared and paid a regular cash dividend of $0.40 per share and a special cash dividend of $0.29 per share. Subsequent to December 31, 2014, the Company declared a regular quarterly cash dividend of $0.10 per share to be paid on February 11, 2015, to shareholders of record as of January 30, 2015.

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS AND COMMITMENTS

In the normal course of business, the Company commits to extensions of credit and issues letters of credit. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments to lend funds and conditional obligations as it does for other credit products. In the event of nonperformance by the customer, the Company’s exposure to credit loss is represented by the contractual amount of the instruments. Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established by the contract. Since some commitments may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. At December 31, 2014, the Company had $156,972 in commitments to extend credit.

Letters of credit written are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee performance of a customer to a third-party. The credit risk involved is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. At December 31, 2014, the Company had $1,564 in letters of credit and financial guarantees written.

 

55


Table of Contents

The Company has certain other financial commitments. These future financial commitments at December 31, 2014, are outlined below:

 

Contractual Obligations    Total      Less than
One Year
     1 - 3
Years
     3 - 5
Years
     More
than 5
Years
 

Junior subordinated debentures

   $ 8,248       $ —         $ —         $ —         $ 8,248   

FHLB borrowings

     96,000         68,500         25,500         —           2,000   

Overnight Fed Funds Borrowed

     —           —           —           —           —     

Time deposits

     155,681         89,929         22,480         14,240         29,032   

Operating lease obligations

     6,960         1,265         1,908         1,558         2,229   

Employment contracts

     725         —           725         —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 267,614    $ 159,694    $ 50,613    $ 15,798    $ 41,509   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

LIQUIDITY AND CASH FLOWS

Liquidity is the term used to define the Company’s ability to meet its financial commitments. The Company maintains sufficient liquidity to ensure funds are available for both lending needs and the withdrawal of deposit funds. The Company derives liquidity through core deposit growth, maturity of investment securities, and loan payments. Core deposits include demand, interest checking, money market, savings, and local time deposits, including local non-public time deposits in excess of $100. Additional liquidity and funding sources are provided through the sale of loans, sales of securities, access to national time deposits markets, and both secured and unsecured borrowings. The Company uses a number of measurements to monitor its liquidity position on a daily, weekly, and monthly basis, which includes its ability to meet both short-term and long-term obligations, and requires the Company to maintain a certain amount of liquidity on the asset side of its balance sheet. The Company also prepares quarterly projections of its liquidity position 30 days, 90 days, 180 days, and one year into the future. In addition, the Company prepares a Liquidity Contingency Plan at least semi-annually that is strategic in nature and forward-looking to test the ability of the Company to fund a liquidity shortfall arising from various escalating events. The Liquidity Contingency Plan is presented and reviewed by the Company’s Asset and Liability Committee.

Core deposits at December 31, 2014, were $1,110,861 and represented 91.88% of total deposits. Core deposits at December 31, 2014, were up $120,546, or 12.17% over December 31, 2013. During 2014, the Company experienced its typical seasonal core deposit pattern, where outflows historically occur during the first six months of the year followed by growth during the second half of the year. The growth in core deposits during 2014 funded the increase in outstanding loans during the year and allowed the Company to reduce use of wholesale funding.

The Company has significant liquidity on the asset side of the balance sheet in the securities portfolio. The securities portfolio represented 23.40% of total assets at December 31, 2014. At December 31, 2014, $36,864 of the securities portfolio was pledged to support public deposits and repurchase accounts, leaving $315,082 of the securities portfolio unencumbered and available-for-sale. The securities portfolio is also available to fund loan growth as approximately $58,900 in cash flows are projected from the portfolio over the next 12 months assuming market interest rates are unchanged. In addition, at December 31, 2014, the Company had $33,111 of government guaranteed loans that could be sold [within 30 days] in the secondary market to support the Company’s liquidity position.

Due to its strategic focus to market to specific segments, the Company has been successful in developing deposit relationships with several large clients, which are generally defined as deposit relationships of $1,000 or more, which are closely monitored by management and Company officers. At December 31, 2014, 62 large deposit relationships with the Company accounted for $490,159, or 44.12% of total outstanding core deposits. The single largest client represented 7.65% of outstanding core deposits at December 31, 2014. The loss of this deposit relationship or other large deposit relationships could cause an adverse effect on short-term liquidity. The Company uses a 10-point risk-rating system to evaluate each of its large depositors in order to assist management in its daily monitoring of the volatility of this portion of its core deposit base. The risk-rating system attempts to determine the stability of the deposits of each large depositor, evaluating, among other things, the length of time the depositor has been with the Company and the likelihood of loss of individual large depositor relationships. Risk ratings on large depositors are reviewed at least quarterly and adjusted if necessary. Company management and officers maintain close relationships and hold regular meetings with the Company’s large depositors to assist in management of these relationships. The Company expects to maintain these relationships, believes it has sufficient sources of liquidity to mitigate the loss of one or more of these clients and regularly tests its ability to mitigate the loss of multiple large depositor relationships in its Liquidity Contingency Plan.

 

56


Table of Contents

At December 31, 2014, the Company had secured borrowing lines with the FHLB and the FRB, along with unsecured borrowing lines with various correspondent banks, totaling $512,938. The Company’s secured lines with the FHLB and the FRB were limited by the amount of collateral pledged. At December 31, 2014, the Company had pledged commercial real estate loans, first and second lien single-family residential loans, and multi-family loans, to the FHLB with a discounted collateral value of $318,854. Additionally, certain commercial and commercial real estate loans with a discounted value of $65,084 were pledged to the FRB under the Company’s Borrower-In-Custody program. The Company’s unsecured correspondent bank lines were $129,000. At December 31, 2014, the Company had $96,000 in borrowings outstanding from the FHLB, $0 outstanding with the FRB, and $0 outstanding on its overnight correspondent bank lines, leaving a total of $416,938 available on its secured and unsecured borrowing lines at such date.

As disclosed in the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows in the Consolidated Financial Statement in this Form 10-K, net cash provided by operating activities was $24,138 for the year 2014. The difference between cash provided by operating activities and net income largely consisted of depreciation and amortization of $6,834. Net cash of $52,200 was used in investing activities for the year 2014, consisting principally of net loan originations of $53,447 and securities purchases of $75,184, which was partially offset by proceeds from maturities of investment securities of $71,622. Cash provided by financing activities was $32,741 for the year 2014.

INFLATION

Substantially all of the assets and liabilities of the Company are monetary. Therefore, inflation has a less significant impact on the Company than does fluctuation in market interest rates. Inflation can lead to accelerated growth in noninterest expenses, which could impact net earnings. During the last several years, inflation, as measured by the Consumer Price Index, did not change significantly. The effects of inflation have not had a material impact on the Company.

 

ITEM 7A Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

The Company’s results of operations are largely dependent upon its ability to manage market risks. Changes in interest rates can have a significant effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. Although permitted by its funds management policy, the Company does not presently use derivatives, such as forward and futures contracts, options or interest rate swaps, to manage interest rate risk. Other types of market risk, such as foreign currency exchange rate risk and commodity price risk, do not arise in the normal course of the Company’s business activities.

Interest rate risk generally arises when the maturity or repricing structure of the Company’s assets and liabilities differ significantly. Asset and liability management, which among other things addresses such risk, is the process of developing, testing and implementing strategies that seek to maximize net interest income while maintaining sufficient liquidity. This process includes monitoring contractual maturity and prepayment expectations together with expected repricing of assets and liabilities under different interest rate scenarios. Generally, the Company seeks a structure that insulates net interest income from large deviations attributable to changes in market rates.

Interest rate risk is managed through the monitoring of the Company’s balance sheet by utilizing two key measurement tools; 1) Economic Value of Equity (EVE) and Net Interest Income (NII). Economic Value of Equity is a measurement of net present value of Assets less Liabilities. Net interest income is a measurement of interest income less interest expense over a specified time horizon (usually 12, 24 and/or 36 months). Both measurements incorporate instantaneous parallel rate shocks of -100, +100, +200, +300, and +400 basis points. In addition, key assumptions are applied to the analysis covering asset prepayments, liability decays and betas, and repricing characteristics. Other interest rate risk analysis includes stress-testing, back-testing, and forecast. Stress-testing the model provides a measurement of worst-case analysis and a degree of tolerance to the base model. Back-testing analysis provides a degree of validity of the base model as compared to actual results. Forecast provides management the what-if scenarios with predetermined balance and rate growth assumptions. In addition, forecasting takes into account growth in loans and deposits and management strategies that could be employed to maximize the net interest margin and net interest income.

The Company utilizes in-house asset/liability modeling software, ProfitStar, to determine the effect changes that interest rates have on Economic Value of Equity and Net Interest Income. Economic Value of Equity provides a long-term risk profile while Net Interest Income provides a short-term risk profile of the balance sheet. Although certain assets and liabilities may have similar

 

57


Table of Contents

repricing characteristics, they may not react correspondingly to changes in market interest rates. In the event of a change in interest rates, prepayment of loans and early withdrawal of time deposits would likely deviate from those previously assumed. Increases in market rates may also affect the ability of certain borrowers to make scheduled principal payments.

The model attempts to account for such limitations by imposing weights on the differences between repricing assets and repricing liabilities within each time segment. These weights are based on the ratio between the amount of rate change of each category of asset or liability and the amount of change in the federal funds rate. Certain non-maturing liabilities, such as checking accounts and money market deposit accounts, are allocated among the various repricing time segments to meet local competitive conditions and management’s strategies.

At December 31, 2014, the Company was liability sensitive, meaning that in a rising rate environment, the net interest margin and net interest income would decline. The Company’s interest rate risk position was primarily due to three factors: 1) active floors on variable rate loans; 2) the composition of the Company’s core deposit base, which consists primarily of non-maturing deposits are subject to immediate repricing, and 3) Company’s overnight borrowings will also reprice immediately.

There are numerous critical assumptions in the modeling of interest rate sensitivity, including the deposit decay rate (the rate at which non-maturing deposits run off over time) and the beta factor (the projected change in rates paid on non-maturing deposits for every 100 basis point increase or decrease in market interest rates). Critical assumptions are based on historical behaviors and current market conditions. Due to the critical nature of these assumptions on the overall calculated interest rate risk position, actual results and changes in net interest income and the net interest margin in the event of an increase or decrease of market interest rates may be materially different from projections.

The following table shows the estimated impact on Net Interest Income at one, two, and three year time horizons and Economic Value of Equity with instantaneous parallel rate shocks of -100, +100, +200, +300, and +400 basis points. Due to the various assumptions used for this modeling and potential balance sheet strategies management may implement to mitigate interest rate risk, no assurance can be given that projections will reflect actual results.

 

58


Table of Contents

Interest Rate Shock Analysis

Net Interest Income and Economic Value of Equity Measurement

($ in thousands)

 

     1st Year Net Interest Income  

Interest

Rate Shocks

   $ Estimated
Value
     $ Change
From Base
     Change
From Base
 

400

     51,646         (4,794      -8.49

300

     52,720         (3,720      -6.59

200

     53,829         (2,611      -4.63

100

     55,074         (1,366      -2.42

Base

     56,440         0         0.00

-100

     55,789         (651      -1.15

 

     2nd Year Net Interest Income  

Interest

Rate Shocks

   $ Estimated
Value
     $ Change
From Base
     Change
From Base
 

400

     58,316         1,223         2.14

300

     57,941         849         1.49

200

     57,622         529         0.93

100

     57,318         226         0.40

Base

     57,093         0         0.00

-100

     55,246         (1,847      -3.23

 

     3rd Year Net Interest Income  

Interest

Rate Shocks

   $ Estimated
Value
     $ Change
From Base
     Change
From Base
 

400

     67,219         9,050         15.56

300

     64,796         6,628         11.39

200

     62,561         4,392         7.55

100

     60,332         2,163         3.72

Base

     58,169         0         0.00

-100

     55,377         (2,791      -4.80

 

     Economic Value of Equity  

Interest

Rate Shocks

   $ Estimated
Value
     $ Change
From Base
     Change
From Base
 

400

     187,063         3,221         1.75

300

     188,214         4,372         2.38

200

     189,148         5,306         2.89

100

     188,038         4,196         2.28

Base

     183,842         0         0.00

-100

     198,336         14,494         7.88

 

59


Table of Contents
ITEM 8 Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders

Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014. We also have audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Report of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements and an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the consolidated financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall consolidated financial statements presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

60


Table of Contents

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014 based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

/s/ Moss Adams LLP

Portland, Oregon

March 13, 2015

 

61


Table of Contents

Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(In thousands, except share amounts)

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013  

ASSETS

     

Cash and due from banks

   $ 20,929       $ 19,410   

Interest-bearing deposits with banks

     4,858         1,698   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total cash and cash equivalents

  25,787      21,108   

Securities available-for-sale

  351,946      347,386   

Loans, less allowance for loan losses and net deferred fees

  1,029,384      977,928   

Interest receivable

  4,773      4,703   

Federal Home Loan Bank stock

  10,019      10,425   

Property and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation

  17,820      18,836   

Goodwill and intangible assets

  23,495      23,616   

Deferred tax asset

  4,464      9,598   

Other real estate owned

  13,374      16,355   

Bank-owned life insurance

  16,609      16,136   

Other assets

  6,654      3,635   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

$ 1,504,325    $ 1,449,726   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

Deposits

Noninterest-bearing demand

$ 407,311    $ 366,891   

Savings and interest-bearing checking

  646,101      559,632   

Core time deposits

  57,449      63,792   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total core deposits

  1,110,861      990,315   

Other deposits

  98,232      100,666   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deposits

  1,209,093      1,090,981   

Federal funds and overnight funds purchased

  —        5,150   

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

  96,000      160,000   

Junior subordinated debentures

  8,248      8,248   

Accrued interest and other payables

  6,823      6,163   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

  1,320,164      1,270,542   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commitments and Contingencies (Note 18)

Shareholders’ equity

Common stock, no par value, shares authorized: 50,000,000; shares issued and outstanding: 17,717,676 at December 31, 2014, and 17,891,687 at December 31, 2013

  131,375      133,835   

Retained earnings

  48,984      45,250   

Accumulated other comprehensive income

  3,802      99   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
  184,161      179,184   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

$ 1,504,325    $ 1,449,726   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

See accompanying notes.

 

62


Table of Contents

Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary

Consolidated Statements of Operations

(In thousands, except per share amounts)

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012  

Interest and dividend income

      

Loans

   $ 53,855      $ 53,275      $ 48,091   

Taxable securities

     6,191        5,730        6,171   

Tax-exempt securities

     1,971        1,918        1,626   

Federal funds sold & interest-bearing deposits with banks

     10        10        6   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  62,027      60,933      55,894   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest expense

Deposits

  3,252      3,389      4,059   

Federal Home Loan Bank & Federal Reserve borrowings

  1,088      1,189      1,584   

Junior subordinated debentures

  225      200      151   

Federal funds purchased

  14      16      24   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  4,579      4,794      5,818   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

  57,448      56,139      50,076   

Provision for loan losses

  —        250      1,900   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

  57,448      55,889      48,176   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noninterest income

Service charges on deposit accounts

  2,134      1,926      1,827   

Other fee income, principally bankcard

  951      1,624      1,595   

Mortgage banking income

  —        —        72   

Bank-owned life insurance income

  473      515      583   

Net loss on sale of investment securities

  (34   (8   —     

Impairment losses on investment securities (OTTI)

  —        (23   —     

Other noninterest income

  1,471      1,792      1,664   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  4,995      5,826      5,741   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noninterest expense

Salaries and employee benefits

  23,555      22,120      19,576   

Property and equipment

  3,735      3,684      3,373   

Data processing

  2,720      2,605      2,096   

Business development

  1,531      1,805      1,558   

Legal and professional services

  1,252      1,867      1,735   

FDIC insurance assessment

  868      912      1,085   

Merger related expense

  470      1,246      203   

Other real estate expense

  449      2,401      1,494   

Bankcard processing

  7      527      580   

Other noninterest expense

  3,142      3,565      3,405   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  37,729      40,732      35,105   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income before income tax provision

  24,714      20,983      18,812   

Income tax provision

  8,672      7,216      6,159   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

$ 16,042    $ 13,767    $ 12,653   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Earnings per share

Basic

$ 0.90    $ 0.77    $ 0.70   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted

$ 0.89    $ 0.76    $ 0.69   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes.

 

63


Table of Contents

Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

(In thousands, except per share amounts)

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012  

Net income

   $ 16,042      $ 13,767      $ 12,653   

Other comprehensive income (loss):

      

Available-for-sale securities:

      

Unrealized gain (loss) arising during the year

     6,266        (9,833     3,733   

Reclassification adjustment for losses realized in net income

     34        8        —     

Other than temporary impairment

     —          23        —     

Income tax (expense) benefit

     (2,457     3,823        (1,456

Derivative agreements—cash flow hedge

      

Unrealized (loss) gain arising during the year

     (230     405        —     

Income tax benefit (expense)

     90        (158     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

  3,703      (5,732   2,277   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

$ 19,745    $ 8,035    $ 14,930   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes.

 

64


Table of Contents

Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity

For the Years Ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012

(In thousands, except share amounts)

 

     Number of
Shares
    Common
Stock
    Retained
Earnings
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income
    Total  

Balance, December 31, 2011

     18,435,084      $ 137,844      $ 37,468      $ 3,554      $ 178,866   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

  12,653      12,653   

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

  2,277      2,277   
        

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income

  14,930   
          

 

 

 

Stock issuance and related tax benefit

  55,807      208      208   

Shares exchanged in payment of option exercise consideration

  (14,166   (129   (129

Stock repurchase

  (641,637   (5,676   (5,676

Share-based compensation expense

  875      875   

Vested employee RSUs and SARs surrendered to cover tax consequence

  (105   (105

Cash dividends

  (5,588   (5,588
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2012

  17,835,088    $ 133,017    $ 44,533    $ 5,831    $ 183,381   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

  13,767      13,767   

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax

  (5,732   (5,732
        

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income

  8,035   
          

 

 

 

Stock issunace

  56,599      —     

Share-based compensation expense

  1,136      1,136   

Vested employee RSUs and SARs surrendered to cover tax consequesnces

  (318   (318

Cash dividends

  (13,050   (13,050
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2013

  17,891,687    $ 133,835    $ 45,250    $ 99    $ 179,184   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

  16,042      16,042   

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

  3,703      3,703   
        

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income

  19,745   
          

 

 

 

Stock issuance and related tax benefit

  93,069      203      203   

Stock repurchase

  (267,080   (3,600   (3,600

Share-based compensation expense

  1,454      1,454   

Vested employee RSUs and SARs surrendered to cover tax consequesnces

  (517   (517

Cash dividends

  (12,308   (12,308
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2014

  17,717,676    $ 131,375    $ 48,984    $ 3,802    $ 184,161   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes.

 

65


Table of Contents

Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(In thousands)

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012  

Cash flows from operating activities:

      

Net income

   $ 16,042      $ 13,767      $ 12,653   

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash

      

from operating activities:

      

Depreciation and amortization, net of accretion

     6,834        8,596        9,950   

Valuation adjustment on foreclosed assets

     82        1,948        1,416   

Capitalized other real estate owned costs

     —          (67     (140

Gain on sale of other real estate owned

     (7     —          (130

Provision for loan losses

     —          250        1,900   

Deferred income tax provision

     2,766        743        (314

BOLI income

     (473     (515     (583

Share-based compensation

     1,528        1,196        875   

Excess tax benefit of stock options exercised

     (14     —          (10

Production of mortgage loans held-for-sale

     —          —          (2,259

Proceeds from the sale of mortgage loans held-for-sale

     —          —          3,317   

Other than temporary impairment on investment securities

     —          23        —     

Loss on sale of investment securities

     34        8        —     

Change in:

      

(Increase) decrease in Interest receivable

     (70     67        205   

Deferred loan fees

     66        83        163   

Accrued interest payable and other liabilities

     598        259        2,092   

Income taxes payable

     80        792        1,671   

(Increase) decrease in other assets

     (3,328     138        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

  24,138      27,288      30,806   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

Proceeds from maturities and pay downs available-for-sale investment securities

  71,622      99,228      100,657   

Proceeds from sales of available-for-sale securities

  —        1,851      —     

Purchase of available-for-sale investment securities

  (75,184   (75,340   (148,614

Net loan principal originations

  (53,447   (61,604   (64,169

Purchase of property and equipment

  (428   (897   (522

Proceeds on sale of foreclosed assets

  4,831      489      5,128   

Purchase of energy tax credits

  —        —        (14

Redemption of FHLB stock

  406      391      190   

Cash consideration paid, net of cash acquired in merger

  —        (2,827   —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used by investing activities

  (52,200   (38,709   (107,344
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

Change in deposits

  118,113      (18,384   80,900   

(Increase) decrease in federal funds purchased and FHLB

short-term borrowings

  (69,150   37,580      29,770   

Proceeds from FHLB term advances originated

  —        —        39,000   

FHLB advances paid-off

  —        (2,000   (53,000

Proceeds from stock options exercised

  189      —        69   

Excess tax benefit of stock options exercised

  14      —        10   

Dividends paid

  (12,308   (13,050   (5,588

Repurchase of common stock

  (3,600   —        (5,676

Vested SARs and RSUs surrendered by employees to cover tax consequence

  (517   (318   (105
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

  32,741      3,828      85,380   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

  4,679      (7,593   8,842   

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year

  21,108      28,701      19,859   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

$ 25,787    $ 21,108    $ 28,701   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental information:

Noncash investing and financing activities:

Transfers of loans to other real estate owned

$ 1,925    $ 753    $ 13,246   

Change in fair value of securities, net of deferred income taxes

$ 3,843    $ (5,979 $ 2,277   

Cash paid during the year for:

Income taxes

$ 8,701    $ 6,906    $ 4,187   

Interest

$ 4,540    $ 4,641    $ 5,710   

See accompanying notes.

 

66


Table of Contents

Pacific Continental Corporation and Subsidiary

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

In preparing these consolidated financial statements, the Company has evaluated events and transactions subsequent to the balance sheet date for potential recognition or disclosure. All dollar amounts in the following notes are expressed in thousands, except per share data.

NOTE 1—SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES:

Principles of Consolidation – The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Pacific Continental Corporation (the “Company”), a bank holding company, and its wholly owned subsidiary, Pacific Continental Bank (the “Bank”) and the Bank’s wholly owned subsidiaries, PCB Service Corporation (which previously owned and operated bank-related real estate but is currently inactive) and PCB Loan Services Corporation (which previously owned and operated certain repossessed or foreclosed collateral but is currently inactive). The Bank provides commercial banking, financing, mortgage lending and other services through fourteen offices located in Western Oregon and Western Washington. The Bank also operates two loan production offices in Tacoma, Washington and Denver, Colorado. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

In November 2005, the Company formed a wholly owned Delaware statutory business trust subsidiary, Pacific Continental Corporation Capital Trust (the “Trust”) which issued $8,248 of guaranteed undivided beneficial interests in the Pacific Continental’s Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest Debentures (“Trust Preferred Securities”). Pacific Continental has not consolidated the accounts of the Trust in its consolidated financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, (“GAAP”). As a result, the junior subordinated debentures issued by Pacific Continental to the issuer trust, totaling $8,248, are reflected on Pacific Continental’s consolidated balance sheet at December 31, 2014, under the caption “Junior Subordinated Debentures.” Pacific Continental also recognized its $248 investment in the Trust, which is recorded among “Other Assets” in its consolidated balance sheet at December 31, 2014.

Use of Estimates – The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. The most significant estimations made by management involve fair value calculations pertaining to financial assets and liabilities, the calculation of the allowance for loan losses, and the impairment assessment for goodwill.

Cash and Cash Equivalents – For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents includes cash on hand, amounts due from or deposited with banks, interest-bearing balances due from banks, and federal funds sold. Generally, federal funds are sold for one-day periods.

The Company is required to maintain certain reserves with the Federal Reserve Bank as defined by regulation. Such reserves totaling $3,123 and $1,430 were maintained within the Company’s cash balances at December 31, 2014, and 2013, respectively.

Securities Available-for-Sale – Securities available-for-sale are held for indefinite periods of time and may be sold in response to movements in market interest rates, changes in the maturity or mix of Company assets and liabilities or demand for liquidity. Management determines the appropriate classification of securities at the time of purchase. The Company classified all of its securities as available-for-sale throughout 2014 and 2013.

Securities classified as available-for-sale are reported at estimated fair value based on available market prices. Net unrealized gains and losses are included in other comprehensive income or loss on an after-tax basis. Impaired securities are assessed quarterly for the presence of other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”). OTTI is considered to have occurred, (1) if we intend to sell the security, (2) if it is “more likely than not” we will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, or (3) the present value of expected cash flows is not sufficient to recover the entire amortized cost basis. The “more likely than not” criteria is a lower threshold than the “probable” criteria used under previous guidance.

 

67


Table of Contents

When OTTI is identified, the amount of the impairment is bifurcated into two components: the amount representing credit loss and the amount related to all other factors. The amount representing credit loss is recognized against earnings as a realized loss and the amount representing all other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income as an unrealized loss. Gains and losses on the sale of available-for-sale securities are determined using the specific-identification method. Purchase premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income using the interest method over the terms of the securities. Interest income on securities available-for-sale is included in income using the level yield method.

Loans, Income Recognition, and the Allowance for Loan Losses – Loans are stated at the amount of unpaid principal net of loan premiums or discounts for purchased loans, net deferred loan origination fees, discounts associated with retained portions of loans sold, and an allowance for loan losses. Interest on loans is calculated using the simple-interest method on daily balances of the principal amount outstanding. Loan origination fees, net of origination costs and discounts, are amortized over the lives of the loans as adjustments to yield.

Nonaccrual Loans

Accrual of interest is discontinued on contractually delinquent loans when management believes that, after considering economic and business conditions and collection efforts, the borrower’s financial condition is such that collection of principal or interest is doubtful. At a minimum, loans that are past due as to maturity or payment of principal or interest by 90 days or more are placed on nonaccrual status, unless such loans are well-secured and in the process of collection. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received satisfying all delinquent principal and interest amounts, and the prospects for future payments in accordance with the loan agreement appear relatively certain. In accordance with GAAP, payments received on nonaccrual loans are applied to the principal balance and no interest income is recognized.

Allowance for Loan Losses Methodology

Management provides for possible loan losses by maintaining an allowance. The allowance for loan losses is established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense. Loans are charged against the allowance when management believes the collection of principal or interest is unlikely. The allowance is an amount that management considers adequate to absorb possible losses on existing loans based on its evaluation of the collectability of those loans and prior loss experience. Management’s evaluations take into consideration such factors as changes in the size and nature of the loan portfolio, the overall portfolio quality, the financial condition of borrowers, the level of nonperforming loans, the Company’s historical loss experience, the estimated value of underlying collateral, and current economic conditions that may affect the borrower’s ability to pay. This evaluation is inherently subjective as it requires estimates that are susceptible to significant subsequent revision as more information becomes available.

The allowance consists of general, specific and unallocated components. The general component covers all loans not specifically identified for impairment testing. The specific component relates to loans that are individually assessed for impairment. The combined general and specific components of the allowance constitute the Company’s allocated allowance for loan losses. An unallocated allowance may be maintained to provide for credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio that may not have been contemplated in the general risk factors or the specific allowance analysis.

The Company performs regular credit reviews of the loan portfolio to determine the credit quality of the portfolio and the Company’s adherence to underwriting standards. When loans are originated, they are assigned a risk rating that is reassessed periodically during the terms of the loans through the credit review process. The risk rating categories constitute a primary factor in determining an appropriate amount for the general allowance for loan losses. The general allowance is calculated by applying risk factors to pools of outstanding loans. Risk factors are assigned based on management’s evaluation of the losses inherent within each identified loan category. Loan categories with greater risk of loss are therefore assigned a higher risk factor. The Company’s Asset and Liability Committee (“ALCO”) and Board of Directors are responsible for, among other things, regularly reviewing the allowance for loan losses methodology, including loss factors, and ensuring that it is designed and applied in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

Regular credit reviews of the portfolio are performed to identify loans that are considered potentially impaired. Potentially impaired loans are referred to the ALCO Committee which reviews loans recommended for impairment. A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, the Company is unlikely to collect all principal and interest due according to the terms of the loan agreement. When a loan is deemed to be impaired, the amount of the impairment is measured using discounted cash flows except when the sole remaining source of the repayment is the liquidation of the collateral. In these cases, the current fair value of the collateral, less selling costs is used. Impairment is

 

68


Table of Contents

recognized as a specific component within the allowance for loan losses if the value of the impaired loan is less than the recorded investment in the loan. When the amount of the impairment represents a confirmed loss, it is charged off against the allowance for loan losses. Loans specifically reviewed for impairment are excluded from the general allowance calculation to prevent double-counting the loss exposure. The Company’s ALCO Committee reviews loans recommended for impaired status and those recommended to be removed from impaired status. The Company’s ALCO Committee and Board provide oversight of the allowance for loan losses process and review and approve the allowance methodology on a quarterly basis.

During the second quarter 2013, the Company changed to full migration analysis from the method of probability of default and loss given default, to determine the appropriate amount of general reserves. This method of analysis involves tracking the loss experience on a rolling population of loans over a period of several quarters and the collection and analysis of historical data to determine what rate of loss the Bank has incurred on similarly criticized loans and how the current portfolio could migrate to loss. The change in methodology did not have a material impact on the allowance for loan losses calculation.

Charge off Methodology

When it becomes evident that a loan has a probable loss and is deemed uncollectable, regardless of delinquent status, the loan is charged off. A partial charge-off will occur to the extent of the portion of the loan that is not well secured and is in the process of collection. Additionally, a partial charge-off will occur to the extent of the portion of the loan that is not guaranteed by a federal or state government agency and is in the process of collection. In circumstances whereby it is evident that a government guarantee will not be honored, the loan will be charged-off to the extent of the portion of the loan that is not well secured. Commercial overdrafts will be charged-off within the month the delinquent checking account becomes 90 days delinquent.

Troubled Debt Restructuring

Loans are reported as a troubled debt restructuring when the Company grants a concession to a borrower experiencing financial difficulties that it would not otherwise consider. Examples of such concessions include a reduction in the loan rate, forgiveness of principal or accrued interest, extending the maturity date, or providing a lower interest rate than would be normally available for a transaction of similar risk. The Company will undertake a restructuring only when it occurs in ways which improve the likelihood that the credit will be repaid in full under the modified terms and in accordance with a reasonable repayment schedule.

Off-Balance Sheet Credit Exposure – A reserve for unfunded commitments is maintained at a level that, in the opinion of management, is adequate to absorb probable losses associated with the Company’s commitment to lend funds under existing agreements such as letters or lines of credit. Management determines the adequacy of the reserve for unfunded commitments based upon reviews of individual credit facilities, current economic conditions, the risk characteristics of the various categories of commitments and other relevant factors. These factors include the quality of the current loan portfolio: the trend in the loan portfolio’s risk ratings, current economic conditions, loan concentrations, loan growth rates, past-due and nonperforming trends, evaluation of specific loss estimates for all significant problem loans, historical charge-off and recovery experience, and other pertinent information. The reserve is based on estimates and ultimate losses may vary from the current estimates. These estimates are evaluated on a regular basis and, as adjustments become necessary, they are reported in earnings in the periods in which they become known. Draws on unfunded commitments that are considered uncollectible at the time funds are advanced are charged to the allowance. Provisions for unfunded commitment losses and recoveries on loans commitments previously charged-off are added to the reserve for unfunded commitments, which is included in the Other Liabilities section of the consolidated balance sheets. At December 31, 2014, the reserve for unfunded loan commitments totaled $227 compared to $226 at December 31, 2013.

Foreclosed Assets – Assets acquired through foreclosure, or deeds in lieu of foreclosure, are initially recorded at fair value less the estimated cost of disposal, at the date of foreclosure. Any excess of the loan’s balance over the fair value of the foreclosed collateral is charged to the allowance for loan losses.

Improvements to foreclosed assets are capitalized to the extent that the improvements increase the fair value of the assets. Expenditures for routine maintenance and repairs of foreclosed assets are charged to expense as incurred. Management performs periodic valuations of foreclosed assets and may adjust the values to the lower of carrying amount or fair value less the estimated costs to sell. Write downs to net realizable value, if any, and disposition gains or losses are included in noninterest income or expense.

 

69


Table of Contents

Federal Home Loan Bank Stock – The investment in Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) stock is carried at par value, which approximates its fair value. As a member of the FHLB system, the Company is required to maintain a minimum level of investment in FHLB stock based on specific percentages of its outstanding mortgages, total assets or FHLB advances.

FHLB stock is generally viewed as long-term investment. Accordingly, when evaluating FHLB stock for impairment its value is determined based on the ultimate recoverability of the par value rather than by recognizing temporary declines in value. The determination of whether the decline affects the ultimate recoverability is influenced by criteria such as the following:

 

    The significance of the decline in net assets of the FHLBs as compared to the capital stock amount for the FHLBs and the length of time this situation has persisted.

 

    Commitments by the FHLBs to make payments required by law or regulation and the level of such payments in relation to the operating performance of the FHLBs.

 

    The impact of legislative and regulatory changes on the institution and, accordingly, on the customer base of the FHLBs.

 

    The liquidity position of the FHLBs.

Property, Plant and Equipment – Property is stated at cost, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization. Additions, betterments and replacements of major units are capitalized. Expenditures for normal maintenance, repairs and replacements of minor units are charged to expense as incurred. Gains or losses realized from sales or retirements are reflected in operations currently.

Depreciation and amortization is computed by the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Estimated useful lives are 30 to 40 years for buildings, 3 to 10 years for furniture and equipment, and up to the lesser of the useful life or lease term for leasehold improvements.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets – Intangible assets are comprised of goodwill and other intangibles acquired in business combinations. Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortized. Intangible assets with definite useful lives are amortized to their estimated residual values over their respective estimated useful lives, and also reviewed for impairment. The Company performs a goodwill impairment analysis on an annual basis as of December 31. Additionally, the Company performs a goodwill impairment evaluation on an interim basis when events or circumstances indicate impairment potentially exists. A significant amount of judgment is involved in determining if an indicator of impairment has occurred. Such indicators may include, among others, a significant decline in our expected future cash flows; a sustained, significant decline in our stock price and market capitalization; a significant adverse change in legal factors or in the business climate; adverse action or assessment by a regulator; and unanticipated competition.

Bank-owned Life Insurance – Bank-owned life insurance is recorded at the estimated cash-surrender value of the policies. Increases in the cash-surrender value are recorded as noninterest income.

Advertising – Advertising costs are charged to expense during the year in which they are incurred. Advertising expenses were $745, $894, and $779, for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

Income Taxes – Income taxes are accounted for using the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the expected future tax consequences attributable to differences between financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are calculated using tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. Valuation allowances are established to reduce the net carrying amount of deferred tax assets if it is determined to be more likely than not that all or some of the potential deferred tax asset will not be realized.

 

70


Table of Contents

The Company follows the provisions of the Financial Accounting Standards Boards’ (“FASB”) ASC 740, “Income Taxes,” relating to accounting for uncertain tax positions. Uncertain tax positions may arise when the Company takes or expects to take a tax position that is ultimately disallowed by the relevant taxing authority. The Company files income tax returns with the Internal Revenue Service and any states in which it has identified that it has nexus. Tax returns for the years subsequent to 2009 remain open to examination by the taxing jurisdictions. Management reviews the Company’s balance sheet, income statement, income tax provision and income tax returns as well as the permanent and temporary adjustments affecting current and deferred income taxes quarterly and assesses whether uncertain tax positions exist. At December 31, 2014, management does not believe that any uncertain tax positions exist, that are not more-likely-than-not, sustainable upon examination. The Company’s policy with respect to interest and penalties ensuing from income tax settlements is to recognize them as noninterest expense.

Earnings Per Share – Basic earnings per share are computed by dividing net income by the weighted average number of shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings per share include the effect of common stock equivalents that would arise from the exercise of stock options discussed in Note 15. Weighted shares outstanding are adjusted retroactively for the effect of stock dividends.

 

     Weighted average shares outstanding as of
December 31,
 
     2014      2013      2012  

Basic

     17,812,740         17,871,439         18,085,607   

Common stock equivalents attributable to stock-based compensation plans

     223,448         188,484         152,553   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diluted

  18,036,188      18,059,923      18,238,160   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity grants, including options and Stock Appreciation Rights, for 323,933, 368,705 and 452,480 shares of common stock were excluded from the diluted earnings per share calculation in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, due to their anti-dilutive effect.

Share-Based Payment Plans – Financial accounting standards require companies to measure and recognize compensation expense for all share-based payments at the grant date based on the fair value of the award, as defined in FASB ASC 718, “Stock Compensation,” and include such costs as an expense in their income statements over the requisite service (vesting) period. The Company estimates the impact of forfeitures based on historical experience with previously granted share-based compensation awards, and considers the impact of the forfeitures when determining the amount of expense to record. The Company generally issues new shares of common stock to satisfy stock option exercises. The Company uses the Black-Scholes option pricing model to measure fair value. No options or Stock Appreciation Rights (“SARs”) were granted in 2013 or 2014. ISOs, nonqualified stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, and stock-settled SARs are recognized as equity-based awards and compensation expense is recorded to the income statement over the requisite vesting period based on the grant-date fair value. SARs settled in cash are recognized on the balance sheet as liability-based awards. The grant-date fair value of liability-based awards vesting in the current period, along with the change in fair value of the awards during the period, are recognized as compensation expense and as an adjustment to the recorded liability.

Fair Value Measurements – Generally accepted accounting principles define fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. FASB ASC 820, “Fair Value Measurements,” establishes a three-level hierarchy for disclosure of assets and liabilities recorded at fair value. The classification of assets and liabilities within the hierarchy is based on whether the inputs to the valuation methodology used for measurement are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect market-derived or market-based information obtained from independent sources while unobservable inputs reflect our estimates about market data. In general, fair values determined by Level 1 inputs utilize quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets that the Company has the ability to access. Fair values determined by Level 2 inputs utilize inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. Level 2 inputs include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets and inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability, such as interest rates and yield curves that are observable at commonly quoted intervals. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability and include situations where there is little, if any, market activity for the asset or liability. In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In such cases, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement in its entirety falls has been determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety. The Company’s assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment, and considers factors specific to the asset or liability.

 

71


Table of Contents

Operating Segments – Public enterprises are required to report certain information about their operating segments in a complete set of financial statements to shareholders. They are also required to report certain enterprise-wide information about the Company’s products and services, its activities in different geographic areas and its reliance on major customers. The basis for determining the Company’s operating segments is the manner in which management operates the business. As of December 31, 2014, the Company operated under one segment.

 

72


Table of Contents

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

In February 2013, the FASB issued ASU No. 2013-02, Reporting of Amounts Reclassified Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income. The Update requires an entity to provide information about the amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by component and to present either on the face of the statement where net income is presented, or in the notes, significant amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by the respective line items of net income, but only if the amount reclassified is required to be reclassified to net income in its entirety in the same reporting period. The amendments are effective for annual and interim reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2013. The adoption of ASU No. 2013-02 did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In July 2013, the FASB issued ASU No. 2013-10, Inclusion of the Fed Funds Effective Swap Rate (or Overnight Index Swap Rate) as a Benchmark Interest Rate for Hedge Accounting Purposes. ASU No. 2013-10 permits the use of the Fed Funds Effective Swap Rate (OIS) to be used as a U.S. benchmark interest rate for hedge account purposes. The amendment is effective prospectively for qualifying new or redesiginated hedging relationships entered into on or after July 17, 2013. The adoption of ASU No. 2013-10 did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In July 2013, the FASB issued ASU No. 2013-11, Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists. ASU No. 2013-11 requires an entity to present an unrecognized tax benefit, or a portion of an unrecognized tax benefit, as a reduction to a deferred tax asset for a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward, except to the extent a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward is not available at the reporting date under the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction to settle any additional income taxes that would result from the disallowance of a tax position or the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction does not require the entity to use, and the entity does not intend to use, the deferred tax asset for such purpose, the unrecognized tax benefit should be presented in the financial statements as a liability and should not be combined with deferred tax assets. No new recurring disclosures are required. The amendments are effective for annual and interim reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2013 and are to be applied prospectively to all unrecognized tax benefits that exist at the effective date. Retrospective application is permitted. The adoption of ASU No. 2013-11 is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In January 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-01, Accounting for Investments in Qualified Affordable Housing Projects. ASU 2014-04 permit an entity to make an accounting policy election to account for their investments in qualified affordable housing projects using the proportional amortization method if certain conditions are met. Under the proportional amortization method, an entity amortizes the initial cost of the investment in proportion to the tax credits and other tax benefits received and recognize the net investment performance in the income statement as a component of income tax expense (benefit). The amendments are effective for annual and interim reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2014 and should be applied prospectively. The Company is currently reviewing the requirements of ASU No. 2014-01, but does not expect the ASU to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In January 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-04, Reclassification of Residential Real Estate Collateralized Consumer Mortgage Loans upon foreclosure. ASU 2014-04 clarifies that an in substance repossession or foreclosure occurs, and a creditor is considered to have received physical possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a consumer mortgage loan, upon either (1) the creditor obtaining legal title to the residential real estate property upon completion of a foreclosure or (2) the borrower conveying all interest in the residential real estate property to the creditor to satisfy that loan through completion of a deed in lieu of foreclosure or through a similar legal agreement. Additionally, the amendments require interim and annual disclosure of both (1) the amount of foreclosed residential real estate property held by the creditor and (2) the recorded investment in consumer mortgage loans collateralized by residential real estate property that are in the process of foreclosure according to local requirements of the applicable jurisdiction. The amendments are effective for annual and interim reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2014 and can be applied with a modified retrospective transition method or prospectively. The adoption of ASU No. 2014-04 is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

73


Table of Contents

In June 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-11, Transfers and Servicing Repurchase-to-Maturity Transactions, Repurchase Financings, and Disclosures. ASU 2014-11 improves the financial reporting of repurchase agreements and other similar transactions by introducing two accounting changes: (1) repurchase-to-maturity transactions will be accounted for as secured borrowing transactions on the balance sheet; previously, they were accounted for as sales when certain conditions were met, and (2) for repurchase financing arrangements, an entity will account separately for a transfer of a financial asset executed contemporaneously with a repurchase agreement with the same counterparty. It also requires enhanced disclosures about repurchase agreements and other similar transactions. This ASU is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning after December 15, 2014. The adoption of ASU No. 2014-11 is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In June 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-12, Accounting for Share-Based Payments When the Terms of an Award Provide That a Performance Target Could Be Achieved after the Requisite Service Period. ASU 2014-12 was issued to clarify that a performance target in a share-based payment that affects vesting and that could be achieved after the requisite service period should be accounted for as a performance condition under Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) 718, Compensation — Stock Compensation. As a result, the target is not reflected in the estimation of the award’s grant date fair value. Compensation cost would be recognized over the required service period, if it is probable that the performance condition will be achieved. The amendments in this ASU can be applied prospectively or retrospectively and are effective for annual periods and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2015 with early adoption permitted. The adoption of ASU No. 2014-12 is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In August 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-14, Classification of Certain Government-Guaranteed Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure. ASU 2014-14 requires that a mortgage loan be derecognized and that a separate other receivable be recognized upon foreclosure if the following conditions are met (1) the loan has a government guarantee that is not separable from the loan before foreclosure; (2) at the time of foreclosure, the creditor has the intent to convey the real estate property to the guarantor and make a claim on the guarantee, and the creditor has the ability to recover under that claim, and (3) at the time of foreclosure, any amount of the claim that is determined on the basis of the fair value of the real estate is fixed. Upon foreclosure, the separate other receivable should be measured based on the amount of the loan balance (principal and interest) expected to be recovered from the guarantor. This ASU is effective for annual periods and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2015 with early adoption permitted. The adoption of ASU No. 2014-14, is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

Subsequent events – The Company has evaluated events and transactions subsequent to December 31, 2014, for potential recognition or disclosure. See Note 22 of this form 10-K for additional information.

Reclassifications – Certain amounts contained in the 2013 and 2012 consolidated financial statements have been reclassified where appropriate to conform to the financial statement presentation used in 2014. These reclassifications had no effect on previously reported net income.

 

74


Table of Contents

NOTE 2—SECURITIES AVAILABLE-FOR-SALE:

The amortized cost and estimated fair values of securities available-for-sale at December 31, 2014, are as follows:

 

     Amortized
Cost
     Gross
Unrealized
Gains
     Gross
Unrealized
Losses
     Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized Loss Positions            

Obligations of U.S. government agencies

   $ 7,573       $ —         $ (72    $ 7,501   

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     11,755         —           (253      11,502   

Private-label mortgage-backed securities

     847         —           (64      783   

Mortgage-backed securities

     64,644         —           (544      64,100   

SBA variable vate pools

     13,059         —           (56      13,003   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 97,878    $ —      $ (989 $ 96,889   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Unrealized Gain Positions

Obligations of U.S. government agencies

$ 31,068    $ 616    $ —      $ 31,684   

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

  69,172      3,307      —        72,479   

Private-label mortgage-backed securities

  2,924      109      —        3,033   

Mortgage-backed securities

  138,306      2,984      —        141,290   

SBA variable rate pools

  6,541      30      —        6,571   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  248,011      7,046      —        255,057   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 345,889    $ 7,046    $ (989 $ 351,946   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2014, unrealized losses exist on certain securities classified as obligations of states and political subdivisions, mortgage-backed securities, and private-label mortgage-backed securities. The unrealized losses on securities that are obligations of states and political subdivision are deemed to be temporary. Additionally, the unrealized losses on agency mortgage-backed securities are deemed to be temporary, as they continue to perform adequately and are backed by various government-sponsored enterprises (“GSEs”). These decreases in fair value are associated with the changes in market interest rates or the widening of market spreads subsequent to the initial purchase of the securities, and not due to concerns regarding the underlying credit of the issuers or the underlying collateral. The decline in value of these securities has resulted from current economic conditions. Although yields on these securities may be below market rates during the period, no loss of principal is expected.

The following table presents a summary of securities in a continuous unrealized loss position as December 31, 2014:

 

     Securities in
Continuous
Unrealized
Loss
Position for
Less Than
12 Months
     Gross
Unrealized Loss
on Securities
in Loss
Position for
Less Than
12 Months
     Securities in
Continuous
Unrealized
Loss
Position for
12 Months
or Longer
     Gross
Unrealized Loss
on Securities
in Loss
Position for
12 Months
or Longer
 

Obligations of U.S. government agencies

   $ 4,564       $ (10    $ 2,936       $ (62

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     2,620         (39      8,883         (214

Private-label mortgage-backed securities

     303         (12      480         (52

Mortgage-backed securities

     40,269         (177      23,831         (366

SBA variable rate pools

     11,833         (49      1,169         (8
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 59,589    $ (287 $ 37,299    $ (702
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

75


Table of Contents

During the fourth quarter 2014 management reviewed all of its private-label mortgage-backed securities for the presence of other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) and determined no additional OTTI was required. Management’s evaluation included the use of independently-generated third-party credit surveillance reports that analyze the loans underlying each security. These reports include estimates of default rates and severities, life collateral loss rates, and static voluntary prepayment assumptions to generate estimated cash flows at the individual security level. Additionally, management considered factors such as downgraded credit ratings, severity and duration of the impairments, the stability of the issuers, and any discounts paid when the securities were purchased. Management has considered all available information related to the collectability of the impaired investment securities and believes that the estimated credit loss is appropriate.

Following is a tabular roll-forward of the amount of credit-related OTTI recognized in earnings during 2014, 2013 and 2012:

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Balance, beginning of period:

   $ 227       $ 204       $ 204   

Additions:

        

OTTI credit loss recorded

     —           23         —     

Less:

        

OTTI reduction from sale or maturity

     —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of period:

$ 227    $ 227    $ 204   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2014, six of the Company’s private-label mortgage-backed securities with an amortized cost of $1,879 were classified as substandard as their ratings were below investment grade. Securities with an amortized cost of $2,593 and $3,281 were classified as substandard at December 31, 2013, and December 31, 2012, respectively.

The projected average life of the securities portfolio is 3.93 years and its modified duration is 3.59 years.

 

76


Table of Contents

The amortized cost and estimated fair values of securities available-for-sale at December 31, 2013, are as follows:

 

     Amortized
Cost
     Gross
Unrealized
Gains
     Gross
Unrealized
Losses
     Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized Loss Positions            

Obligations of U.S. government agencies

   $ 17,268       $ —         $ (276    $ 16,992   

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     40,408         —           (2,180      38,228   

Private-label mortgage-backed securities

     2,679         —           (245      2,434   

Mortgage-backed securities

     103,851         —           (1,928      101,923   

SBA variable rate pools

     3,722         —           (44      3,678   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 167,928    $ —      $ (4,673 $ 163,255   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Unrealized Gain Positions

Obligations of U.S. government agencies

$ 13,515    $ 340    $ —      $ 13,855   

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

  39,210      1,357      —        40,567   

Private-label mortgage-backed securities

  2,790      90      —        2,880   

Mortgage-backed securities

  119,181      2,616      —        121,797   

SBA variable rate pools

  5,004      28      —        5,032   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  179,700      4,431      —        184,131   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 347,628    $ 4,431    $ (4,673 $ 347,386   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table presents a summary of securities in a continuous unrealized loss position as December 31, 2013:

 

     Securities in
Continuous
Unrealized
Loss
Position for
Less Than
12 Months
     Gross
Unrealized Loss
on Securities
in Loss
Position for
Less Than
12 Months
     Securities in
Continuous
Unrealized
Loss
Position for
12 Months
or Longer
     Gross
Unrealized Loss
on Securities
in Loss
Position for
12 Months
or Longer
 

Obligations of U.S. government agencies

   $ 16,992       $ (276    $ —         $ —     

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

     36,873         (2,053      1,356         (127

Private-label mortgage-backed securities

     1,256         (44      1,178         (201

Mortgage-backed securities

     68,647         (1,309      33,275         (619

SBA variable rate pools

     3,678         (44      —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 127,446    $ (3,726 $ 35,809    $ (947
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

77


Table of Contents

The amortized cost and estimated fair value of securities at December 31, 2014, and 2013, are shown below by maturity or projected average life, depending on the type of security. Obligations of U.S. government agencies and states and political subdivisions are shown by contractual maturity. Mortgage-backed securities are shown by projected average life.

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013  
     Amortized
Cost
     Estimated
Fair
Value
     Amortized
Cost
     Estimated
Fair
Value
 

Due in one year or less

   $ 17,072       $ 17,273       $ 18,707       $ 18,870   

Due after one year through 5 years

     220,908         223,540         217,713         219,375   

Due after 5 years through 10 years

     69,523         71,584         66,103         65,432   

Due after 10 years

     38,386         39,549         45,105         43,709   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 345,889    $ 351,946    $ 347,628    $ 347,386   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

During 2014 72 investment securities were sold resulting in proceeds of $25,570, and losses on sales of $34. The specific identification method was used to determine the cost of the securities sold.

During 2013 four investment securities were sold resulting in proceeds of $1,843, and losses on sales of $8. The specific identification method was used to determine the cost of the securities sold.

At December 31, 2014, securities with amortized costs of $31,937 (estimated market values of $32,802) were pledged to secure public deposits, as required by law. At December 31, 2014, securities with an aggregate amortized cost of $3,976 (estimated aggregate market value of $4,062) were pledged for repurchase accounts. At December 31, 2014, there were $93 outstanding on repurchase agreements.

NOTE 3—LOANS, ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES, AND CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS:

Loans are stated at the amount of unpaid principal net of loan premiums or discounts for purchased loans, net deferred loan origination fees, discounts associated with retained portions of loans sold, and an allowance for loan losses. Interest on loans is calculated using the simple-interest method on daily balances of the principal amount outstanding. Loan origination fees, net of origination costs and discounts, are amortized over the lives of the loans as adjustments to yield.

 

78


Table of Contents

Major classifications of loans at December 31 are as follows:

 

     December 31,      % of gross     December 31,      % of gross  
     2014      loans     2013      loans  

Real estate secured loans:

          

Multi-family residential

   $ 51,586         4.9   $ 46,217         4.6

Residential 1-4 family

     47,222         4.5     46,438         4.7

Owner-occupied commercial

     259,805         24.8     249,311         25.1

Nonowner-occupied commercial

     201,558         19.3     158,786         16.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total permanent real estate loans

  560,171      53.5   500,752      50.4

Construction loans:

Multi-family residential

$ 8,472      0.8 $ 23,419      2.4

Residential 1-4 family

  28,109      2.7   26,512      2.7

Commercial real estate

  18,595      1.8   30,516      3.1

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  12,159      1.2   11,473      1.2

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  6,632      0.6   6,990      0.6
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction real estate loans

  73,967      7.1   98,910      10.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  634,138      60.6   599,662      60.4

Commercial loans

  406,568      38.9   390,301      39.2

Consumer loans

  3,862      0.4   3,878      0.3

Other loans

  1,443      0.1   928      0.1
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross loans

  1,046,011      100.0   994,769      100.0

Deferred loan origination fees

  (990   (924
  

 

 

      

 

 

    
  1,045,021      993,845   

Allowance for loan losses

  (15,637   (15,917
  

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total loans, net of allowance for loan losses and net deferred fees

$ 1,029,384    $ 977,928   
  

 

 

      

 

 

    

At December 31, 2014, outstanding loans to dental professionals totaled $306,391 and represented 29.29% of total outstanding loans compared to dental professional loans of $307,268 or 30.89% of total loans at December 31, 2013. Additional information about the Company’s dental portfolio can be found in Item 8, Note 4 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. There are no other industry concentrations in excess of 10.00% of the total loan portfolio. However, as of December 31, 2014, approximately 60.00% of the Company’s loan portfolio was collateralized by real estate and is, therefore, susceptible to changes in local market conditions. While appropriate action is taken to manage identified concentration risks, management believes that the loan portfolio is well diversified by geographic location and among industry groups.

 

79


Table of Contents

Allowance for Loan Losses

A summary of the activity in the allowance for loan losses is as follows for the years ended 2014, 2013, and 2012:

 

     For the twelve months ended December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 15,917       $ 16,345       $ 14,941   

Provision charged to income

     —           250         1,900   

Loans charged against allowance

     (835      (2,088      (3,664

Recoveries credited to allowance

     555         1,410         3,168   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

$ 15,637    $ 15,917    $ 16,345   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The allowance for loan losses is established as an amount that management considers adequate to absorb possible losses on existing loans within the portfolio. The allowance consists of general, specific, and unallocated components. The general component is based upon all loans collectively evaluated for impairment. The specific component is based upon all loans individually evaluated for impairment. The unallocated component represents credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio that may not have been contemplated in the general risk factors or the specific allowance analysis. Loans are charged against the allowance when management believes the collection of principal and interest is unlikely.

The Company performs regular credit reviews of the loan portfolio to determine the credit quality and adherence to underwriting standards. When loans are originated, they are assigned a risk rating that is reassessed periodically during the term of the loan through the credit review process. The Company’s internal risk rating methodology assigns risk ratings ranging from one to ten, where a higher rating represents higher risk. The ten-point risk rating categories are a primary factor in determining an appropriate amount for the allowance for loan losses.

Estimated credit losses reflect consideration of all significant factors that affect the collectability of the loan portfolio. The historical loss rate for each group of loans with similar risk characteristics is determined based on the Company’s own loss experience in that group. Historical loss experience and recent trends in losses provides a reasonable starting point for analysis, however they do not by themselves form a sufficient basis to determine the appropriate level for the allowance for loan losses. Qualitative or environmental factors that are likely to cause estimated credit losses to differ from historical losses are also considered including but not limited to:

 

    Changes in international, regional, and local economic and business conditions and developments that affect the collectability of the portfolio, including the condition of various market segments,

 

    Changes in the nature and volume of the portfolio and in the terms of loans,

 

    Changes in the experience, ability, and depth of lending management and other relevant staff,

 

    Changes in the volume and severity of past due loans, the volume of nonaccrual loans, and the volume and severity of adversely classified or graded loans,

 

    Changes in the quality of the institution’s loan review system,

 

    Changes in the value of underlying collateral for collateral-dependent loans,

 

    The existence and effect of any concentrations of credit, and changes in the level of such concentrations,

 

    The effect of other external factors such as competition and legal and regulatory requirements on the level of estimated credit losses in the institution’s existing portfolio,

 

    Changes in lending policies and procedures, including changes in underwriting standards and collection, charge-off, and recovery practices not considered elsewhere in estimating credit losses.

 

    Changes in the current and future US political environment, including debt ceiling negotiations, government shutdown and healthcare reform that may affect national, regional and local economic conditions, taxation, or

 

    disruption of national or global financial markets.

The adequacy of the allowance for loan losses and the reserve for unfunded commitments is determined using a consistent, systematic methodology and is monitored regularly based on management’s evaluation of numerous factors. For each portfolio segment, these factors include:

 

    The quality of the current loan portfolio,

 

    The trend in the migration of the loan portfolio’s risk ratings,

 

80


Table of Contents
    The velocity of migration of losses and potential losses,

 

    Current economic conditions,

 

    Loan concentrations,

 

    Loan growth rates,

 

    Past-due and nonperforming trends,

 

    Evaluation of specific loss estimates for all significant problem loans,

 

    Recovery experience,

 

    Peer comparison loss rates.

During the second quarter 2013, the Company changed to full migration analysis from the method of probability of default and loss given default, to determine the appropriate amount of general reserves. The Company believes the change provides a more granular analysis accounting for changes in the composition of the portfolio and credit quality deterioration. This method of analysis involves tracking the loss experience on a rolling population of loans over a period of several quarters and the collection and analysis of historical data to determine what rate of loss the Bank has incurred on similarly criticized loans and how the current portfolio could migrate to loss. The change in methodology did not have a material impact on the allowance for loan losses calculation.

 

81


Table of Contents

A summary of the activity in the allowance for loan losses by major loan classification follows:

 

     For the year ended December 31, 2014  
     Commercial
and Other
    Real
Estate
    Construction     Consumer     Unallocated     Total  

Beginning balance

   $ 5,113      $ 7,668      $ 1,493      $ 68      $ 1,575      $ 15,917   

Charge-offs

     (610     (58     (155     (12     —          (835

Recoveries

     348        186        16        5        —          555   

Provision (reclassification)

     882        (302     (277     (7     (296     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

$ 5,733    $ 7,494    $ 1,077    $ 54    $ 1,279    $ 15,637   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     Balances as of December 31, 2014  
     Commercial
and Other
    Real
Estate
    Construction     Consumer     Unallocated     Total  

Ending allowance: collectively evaluated for impairment

   $ 5,662      $ 7,438      $ 959      $ 54      $ 1,279      $ 15,392   

Ending allowance: individually evaluated for impairment

     71        56        118        —          —          245   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total ending allowance

$ 5,733    $ 7,494    $ 1,077    $ 54    $ 1,279    $ 15,637   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending loan balance: collectively evaluated for impairment

$ 405,414    $ 555,146    $ 73,610    $ 3,862    $ —      $ 1,038,032   

Ending loan balance: individually evaluated for impairment

  2,597      5,025      357      —        —        7,979   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total ending loan balance

$ 408,011    $ 560,171    $ 73,967    $ 3,862    $ —      $ 1,046,011   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     For the year ended December 31, 2013  
     Commercial
and Other
    Real
Estate
    Construction     Consumer     Unallocated     Total  

Beginning balance

   $ 3,846      $ 9,456      $ 1,987      $ 70      $ 986      $ 16,345   

Charge-offs

     (1,658     (407     —          (23     —          (2,088

Recoveries

     982        360        60        8        —          1,410   

Provision (reclassification)

     1,943        (1,741     (554     13        589        250   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

$ 5,113    $ 7,668    $ 1,493    $ 68    $ 1,575    $ 15,917   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     Balances as of December 31, 2013  
     Commercial
and Other
    Real
Estate
    Construction     Consumer     Unallocated     Total  

Ending allowance: collectively evaluated for impairment

   $ 5,095      $ 7,667      $ 1,455      $ 68      $ 1,575      $ 15,860   

Ending allowance: individually evaluated for impairment

     18        1        38        —          —          57   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total ending allowance

$ 5,113    $ 7,668    $ 1,493    $ 68    $ 1,575    $ 15,917   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending loan balance: collectively evaluated for impairment

$ 386,332    $ 495,924    $ 98,627    $ 3,878    $ —      $ 984,761   

Ending loan balance: individually evaluated for impairment

  4,897      4,828      283      —        —        10,008   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total ending loan balance

$ 391,229    $ 500,752    $ 98,910    $ 3,878    $ —      $ 994,769   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     For the year ended December 31, 2012  
     Commercial
and Other
    Real
Estate
    Construction     Consumer     Unallocated     Total  

Beginning balance

   $ 2,776      $ 8,267      $ 2,104      $ 87      $ 1,707      $ 14,941   

Charge-offs

     (1,401     (1,190     (1,054     (19     —          (3,664

Recoveries

     1,917        55        1,188        8        —          3,168   

Provision (reclassification)

     554        2,324        (251     (6     (721     1,900   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

$ 3,846    $ 9,456    $ 1,987    $ 70    $ 986    $ 16,345   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

82


Table of Contents

The 2014 ending allowance includes $245 in specific allowance for $7,979 of impaired loans ($6,856 net of government guarantees). At December 31, 2013, the Company had $10,008 of impaired loans ($8,705 net of government guarantees) with a specific allowance of $57 assigned. Management believes that the allowance for loan losses was adequate as of December 31, 2014. However, future loan losses may exceed the levels provided for in the allowance for loan losses and could possibly result in additional charges to the provision for loan losses.

Credit Quality Indicators

The Company uses the following loan grades, which are also often used by regulators when assessing the credit quality of a loan portfolio.

Pass – Credit exposure in this category range between the highest credit quality to average credit quality. Primary repayment sources generate satisfactory debt service coverage under normal conditions. Cash flow from recurring sources is expected to continue to produce adequate debt service capacity. There are many levels of credit quality contained in the pass definition, but none of the loans contained in this category rise to the level of special mention.

Special Mention – A special mention asset has potential weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention. If left uncorrected, these potential weaknesses may result in deterioration of the repayment prospects for the asset or in the institution’s credit position at some future date. Special mention assets are not adversely classified and do not expose an institution to sufficient risk to warrant adverse classification. The Bank strictly and carefully employs the FDIC definition in assessing assets that may apply to this category. It is apparent that in many cases asset weaknesses relevant to this definition either, (1) better fit a definition of a “well-defined weakness,” or (2) in our experience ultimately migrate to worse risk grade categories, such as Substandard and Doubtful. Consequently, management elects to downgrade most potential Special Mention credits to Substandard or Doubtful, and therefore adopts a conservative risk grade process in the use of the Special Mention risk grade.

Substandard – A substandard asset is inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the Borrower or of the collateral pledged, if any. Assets so classified must have a well-defined weakness or weaknesses that jeopardize the liquidation of the debt. Loans in this category are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Company will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. Loss potential, while existing in the aggregate amount of substandard assets, does not have to exist in individual assets classified substandard.

Doubtful – An asset classified doubtful has all the weaknesses inherent in one classified substandard with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable.

Management strives to consistently apply these definitions when allocating its loans by loan grade. The loan portfolio is continuously monitored for changes in credit quality and management takes appropriate action to update the loan risk ratings accordingly. Management has not changed the Company’s policy towards its use of credit quality indicators during the periods reported.

 

83


Table of Contents

The following tables present the Company’s loan portfolio information by loan type and credit grade at December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013:

Credit Quality Indicators

As of December 31, 2014

 

     Loan Grade         
     Pass      Special Mention      Substandard      Doubtful      Totals  

Real estate loans

              

Multi-family residential

   $ 50,074       $ —         $ 1,512       $ —         $ 51,586   

Residential 1-4 family

     39,527         —           7,695         —           47,222   

Owner-occupied commercial

     254,166         —           5,639         —           259,805   

Nonowner-occupied commercial

     197,940         —           3,618         —           201,558   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  541,707      —        18,464      —        560,171   

Construction

Multi-family residential

  8,472      —        —        —        8,472   

Residential 1-4 family

  28,109      —        —        —        28,109   

Commercial real estate

  17,645      —        950      —        18,595   

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  11,917      —        242      —        12,159   

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  5,954      —        678      —        6,632   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  72,097      —        1,870      —        73,967   

Commercial and other

  395,918      —        12,093      —        408,011   

Consumer

  3,854      —        8      —        3,862   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Totals

$ 1,013,576    $ —      $ 32,435    $ —      $ 1,046,011   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit Quality Indicators

As of December 31, 2013

 

     Loan Grade         
     Pass      Special Mention      Substandard      Doubtful      Totals  

Real estate loans

              

Multi-family residential

   $ 44,677       $ —         $ 1,540       $ —         $ 46,217   

Residential 1-4 family

     37,831         —           8,607         —           46,438   

Owner-occupied commercial

     239,539         4,278         5,494         —           249,311   

Nonowner-occupied commercial

     153,055         —           5,731         —           158,786   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  475,102      4,278      21,372      —        500,752   

Construction

Multi-family residential

  23,419      —        —        —        23,419   

Residential 1-4 family

  26,145      —        367      —        26,512   

Commercial real estate

  28,978      —        1,538      —        30,516   

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  11,223      —        250      —        11,473   

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  4,346      —        2,644      —        6,990   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  94,111      —        4,799      —        98,910   

Commercial and other

  378,828      —        12,401      —        391,229   

Consumer

  3,856      —        22      —        3,878   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Totals

$ 951,897    $ 4,278    $ 38,594    $ —      $ 994,769   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

84


Table of Contents

Past Due and Nonaccrual Loans

The Company uses the terms “past due” and “delinquent” interchangeably. Amortizing loans are considered past due or delinquent based upon the number of contractually required payments not made. Delinquency status for all contractually matured loans, commercial and commercial real estate loans with non-monthly amortization, and all other extensions of credit is determined based upon the number of calendar months past due.

The following tables present an aged analysis of past due and nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013:

Aged Analysis of Loans Receivable

As of December 31, 2014

 

     30-59 Days
Past Due
Still Accruing
     60-89 Days
Past Due
Still Accruing
     Greater
Than 90 Days
Still Accruing
     Nonaccrual      Total Past
Due and
Nonaccrual
     Total
Current
     Total Loans
Receivable
 

Real estate loans

                    

Multi-family residential

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ 51,586       $ 51,586   

Residential 1-4 family

     568         —           —           320         888         46,334         47,222   

Owner-occupied commercial

     —           —           —           599         599         259,206         259,805   

Nonowner-occupied commercial

     605         —           —           906         1,511         200,047         201,558   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  1,173      —        —        1,825      2,998      557,173      560,171   

Construction

Multi-family residential

  —        —        —        —        —        8,472      8,472   

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —        —        —        —        28,109      28,109   

Commercial real estate

  —        —        —        —        —        18,595      18,595   

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —        —        12,159      12,159   

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —        —        6,632      6,632   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  —        —        —        —        —        73,967      73,967   

Commercial and other

  327      —        —        870      1,197      406,814      408,011   

Consumer

  4      1      —        —        5      3,857      3,862   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 1,504    $ 1    $ —      $ 2,695    $ 4,200    $ 1,041,811    $ 1,046,011   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aged Analysis of Loans Receivable

As of December 31, 2013

 

     30-59 Days
Past Due
Still Accruing
     60-89 Days
Past Due
Still Accruing
     Greater
Than

90 Days
Still Accruing
     Nonaccrual      Total Past
Due and
Nonaccrual
     Total
Current
     Total Loans
Receivable
 

Real estate loans

                    

Multi-family residential

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ 46,217       $ 46,217   

Residential 1-4 family

     137         —           —           636         773         45,665         46,438   

Owner-occupied commercial

     488         —           —           1,685         2,173         247,138         249,311   

Nonowner-occupied commercial

     1,188         —           —           136         1,324         157,462         158,786   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  1,813      —        —        2,457      4,270      496,482      500,752   

Construction

Multi-family residential

  —        —        —        —        —        23,419      23,419   

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —        —        —        —        26,512      26,512   

Commercial real estate

  —        —        —        —        —        30,516      30,516   

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —        —        11,473      11,473   

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —        —        6,990      6,990   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  —        —        —        —        —        98,910      98,910   

Commercial and other

  436      —        —        2,886      3,322      387,907      391,229   

Consumer

  5      1      —        —        6      3,872      3,878   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 2,254    $ 1    $ —      $ 5,343    $ 7,598    $ 987,171    $ 994,769   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

85


Table of Contents

Impaired Loans

Regular credit reviews of the portfolio are performed to identify loans that are considered potentially impaired. Potentially impaired loans are referred to the Asset-Liability Committee for review and are included in the specific calculation of allowance for loan losses. A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, the Company is unlikely to collect all principal and interest due according to the terms of the loan agreement. When the amount of the impairment represents a confirmed loss it is charged off against the allowance for loan losses. Impaired loans are often reported net of government guarantees to the extent that the guarantees are expected to be collected. Impaired loans generally include all loans classified as nonaccrual and troubled debt restructurings.

Accrual of interest is discontinued on impaired loans when management believes that, after considering economic and business conditions and collection efforts, the borrower’s financial condition is such that collection of principal or interest is doubtful. Accrued, but uncollected interest is generally reversed when loans are placed on nonaccrual status. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received satisfying all delinquent principal and interest amounts, and the prospects for future payments in accordance with the loan agreement appear relatively certain. In accordance with GAAP, payments received on nonaccrual loans are applied to the principal balance and no interest income is recognized. Interest income may be recognized on impaired loans that are not on nonaccrual status.

 

86


Table of Contents

The following tables display an analysis of the Company’s impaired loans at December 31, 2014, and 2013:

Impaired Loan Analysis

As of December 31, 2014

 

     Recorded
Investment
With No
Specific
Allowance
Valuation
     Recorded
Investment
With
Specific
Allowance
Valuation
     Recorded
Investment
     Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Average
Recorded
Investment
     Related
Specific
Allowance
Valuation
 

Real estate

                 

Multi-family residential

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —     

Residential 1-4 family

     564         313         877         1,181         1,123         2   

Owner-occupied commercial

     1,645         —           1,645         1,878         2,372         —     

Nonowner-occupied commercial

     2,449         54         2,503         2,523         1,927         54   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  4,658      367      5,025      5,582      5,422      56   

Construction

Multi-family residential

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Commercial real estate

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        357      357      357      365      118   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  —        357      357      357      365      118   

Commercial and other

  2,025      572      2,597      2,946      3,924      71   

Consumer

  —        —        —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total impaired loans

$ 6,683    $ 1,296    $ 7,979    $ 8,885    $ 9,711    $ 245   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Impaired Loan Analysis

As of December 31, 2013

 

     Recorded
Investment
With No Specific
Allowance
Valuation
     Recorded
Investment
With Specific
Allowance
Valuation
     Recorded
Investment
     Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Average
Recorded
Investment
     Related
Specific
Allowance
Valuation
 

Real estate

                 

Multi-family residential

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —     

Residential 1-4 family

     912         317         1,229         1,633         2,229         1   

Owner-occupied commercial

     2,767         —           2,767         3,000         3,359         —     

Nonowner-occupied commercial

     832         —           832         835         799         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  4,511      317      4,828      5,468      6,387      1   

Construction

Multi-family residential

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Commercial real estate

  —        —        —        —        —        —     

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —        133      —     

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        283      283      373      413      38   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  —        283      283      373      546      38   

Commercial and other

  4,368      529      4,897      10,627      4,100      18   

Consumer

  —        —        —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total impaired loans

$ 8,879    $ 1,129    $ 10,008    $ 16,468    $ 11,033    $ 57   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

87


Table of Contents

The impaired balances reported above are not adjusted for government guarantees of $1,123 and $1,532 at December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, respectively. The recorded investment in impaired loans, net of government guarantees totaled $6,856 and $8,476 at December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, respectively.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

In the normal course of business, the Company may modify the terms of certain loans, attempting to protect as much of its investment as possible. Management evaluates the circumstances surrounding each modification to determine whether it is a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”). TDRs exist when 1) the restructuring constitutes a concession, and 2) the debtor is experiencing financial difficulties.

The following table displays the Company’s TDRs by class at December 31, 2014, and 2013:

 

     Troubled Debt Restructurings as of  
     December 31, 2014      December 31, 2013  
     Number of
Contracts
     Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
     Number of
Contracts
     Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
 

Real estate

           

Multifamily residential

     —         $ —           —         $ —     

Residential 1-4 family

     7         768         7         819   

Owner-occupied commercial

     2         1,046         5         1,949   

Non owner-occupied commercial

     7         2,503         2         714   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  16      4,317      14      3,482   

Construction

Multifamily residential

  —        —        —        —     

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial real estate

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —     

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial and other

  12      2,259      10      2,379   

Consumer

  —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  28    $ 6,576      24    $ 5,861   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The recorded investment in TDRs in nonaccrual status totaled $1,649 and $1,597 at December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, respectively. The Bank’s policy is that loans placed on non-accrual will typically remain on non-accrual status until all principal and interest payments are brought current and the prospect for future payment in accordance with the loan agreement appear relatively certain. The Bank’s policy generally refers to six months of payment performance as sufficient to warrant a return to accrual status.

For the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, the Company identified nine TDRs that are newly considered impaired for which impairment was previously measured under the Company’s general loan loss allowance methodology. The total recorded investment in such receivables was $3,123, and the associated allowance for loan losses was $46 at December 31, 2014.

The types of modifications offered can generally be described in the following categories:

Rate Modification —A modification in which the interest rate is modified.

Term Modification —A modification in which the maturity date, timing of payments, or frequency of payments is changed.

Interest Only Modification —A modification in which the loan is converted to interest only payments for a period of time.

Combination Modification —Any other type of modification, including the use of multiple types of modifications.

 

88


Table of Contents

The following tables present newly restructured loans that occurred during the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, and 2013, respectively:

 

     Troubled Debt Restructurings  
     Identified during the twelve months ended December 31, 2014  
     Rate
Modification
     Term
Modification
     Interest Only
Modification
     Combination
Modification
 

Real estate

           

Multifamily residential

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —     

Residential 1-4 family

     —           —           —           —     

Owner-occupied commercial

     —           —           —           —     

Non owner-occupied commercial

     —           1,597         548         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  —        1,597      548      —     

Construction

Multifamily residential

  —        —        —        —     

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial real estate

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —     

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial and other

  221      274      483      —     

Consumer

  —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 221    $ 1,871    $ 1,031    $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     Troubled Debt Restructurings  
     Identified during the twelve months ended December 31, 2013  
     Rate
Modification
     Term
Modification
     Interest Only
Modification
     Combination
Modification
 

Real estate

           

Multifamily residential

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —     

Residential 1-4 family

     317         —           —           —     

Owner-occupied commercial

     —           —           —           —     

Non owner-occupied commercial

     578         —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  895      —        —        —     

Construction

Multifamily residential

  —        —        —        —     

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial real estate

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —     

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial and other

  —        773      524      674   

Consumer

  —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 895    $ 773    $ 524    $ 674   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

89


Table of Contents

Subsequent to a loan being classified as a TDR, a borrower may become unwilling or unable to abide by the terms of the modified agreement. In such cases of default, the Company takes appropriate action to secure additional payments including the use of foreclosure proceedings. The following table presents loans receivable modified as troubled debt restructurings that subsequently defaulted within twelve months during the period:

 

     Troubled Debt Restructurings  
     That Subsequently Defaulted within the  
     12 months ended December 31,  
     2014      2013  
     Number of
Contracts
     Recorded
Investment
     Number of
Contracts
     Recorded
Investment
 

Real estate

           

Multifamily residential

     —         $ —           —         $ —     

Residential 1-4 family

     —           —           —           —     

Owner-occupied commercial

     —           —           1         303   

Non owner-occupied commercial

     3         548         1         136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  3      548      2      439   

Construction

Multifamily residential

  —        —        —        —     

Residential 1-4 family

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial real estate

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —     

Residential bare land and acquisition & development

  —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total construction loans

  —        —        —        —     

Commercial and other

  —        —        3      144   

Consumer

  —        —        —        —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  3    $ 548      5    $ 583   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, the Company had no commitments to lend additional funds on loans restructured as TDRs.

 

90


Table of Contents

NOTE 4 – DENTAL LOAN PORTFOLIO:

To assist in understanding the concentrations and risks associated with the Bank’s loan portfolio, the following Note has been included to provide additional information relating to the Bank’s dental lending portfolio. At December 31, 2014, and 2013, loans to dental professionals totaled $306,391 and $307,268, respectively and represented 29.29% and 30.89% of outstanding loans. As of December 31, 2014, and 2013, dental loans supported by government guarantees totaled $12,700 and $16,470. This represented 4.15% and 5.36% of the outstanding dental loan balances.

The Company defines a “dental loan” as loan to dental professionals for the purpose of practice expansion, acquisition or other purpose, supported by the cash flows of a dental practice.

Loan Classification

Major classifications of Dental Loans, at December 31, 2014, and 2013, are as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013  

Real estate secured loans:

     

Owner-occupied commercial

   $ 60,092       $ 59,279   

Other dental real estate loans

     2,785         1,967   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total permanent real estate loans

  62,877      61,246   

Dental construction loans

  604      5,810   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total real estate loans

  63,481      67,056   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial loans

  242,910      240,212   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross loans

$ 306,391    $ 307,268   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Market Area

The Bank’s defined “market area” is within the states of Oregon and Washington west of the Cascade Mountain Range. This area is serviced by branch locations in Eugene, Portland and Seattle. The Company also makes national dental loans throughout the United States. National loan relationships are maintained and serviced by Bank personnel primarily located in Portland.

The following table represents the dental lending by borrower location:

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013  

Local

   $ 159,425       $ 178,673   

National

     146,966         128,595   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 306,391    $ 307,268   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

91


Table of Contents

Allowance

The allowance for loan losses identified for the Dental Loan Portfolio is established as an amount that management considers adequate to absorb possible losses on existing loans within the Dental Portfolio. The allowance related to the Dental Loan Portfolio consists of general and specific components. The general component is based upon all Dental Loans collectively evaluated for impairment, including qualitative conditions associated with; loan type, out-of-market location, start-up financing, practice acquisition financing and specialty practice financing. The specific component is based upon Dental Loans individually evaluated for impairment.

 

     Twelve months ended December 31,  
     2014      2013  

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 3,730       $ 2,683   

Provision charged to income

     918         2,208   

Loans charged against allowance

     (631      (1,232

Recoveries credited to allowance

     124         71   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

$ 4,141    $ 3,730   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit Quality

Please refer to Note 3 for additional information on the definitions of the credit quality indicators.

The following tables present the Company’s dental loan portfolio information by market and credit grade at December 31, 2014, and 2013:

 

Dental Credit Quality Indicators

As of December 31, 2014

 
       Loan Grade           
       Pass        Special
Mention
       Substandard        Doubtful        Totals  

Local

     $ 156,589         $ —           $ 2,836         $ —           $ 159,425   

National

       144,120           —             2,846           —             146,966   
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total

$ 300,709    $ —      $ 5,682    $ —      $ 306,391   
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Dental Credit Quality Indicators

As of December 31, 2013

  

  

       Loan Grade           
       Pass        Special
Mention
       Substandard        Doubtful        Totals  

Local

     $ 172,708         $ —           $ 5,965         $ —           $ 178,673   

National

       127,842           —             753           —             128,595   
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total

$ 300,550    $ —      $ 6,718    $ —      $ 307,268   
    

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

 

92


Table of Contents

Past Due and Nonaccrual Loans

Please refer to Note 3 for additional information on the definitions of “past due.”

The following tables present an aged analysis of the dental loans by market, including nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2014, and 2013:

Aged Analysis of Dental Loans Receivable

As of December 31, 2014

 

     30-59 Days
Past Due
Still Accruing
     60-89 Days
Past Due
Still Accruing
     Greater Than
90 Days
Still Accruing
     Nonaccrual      Total Past
Due and
Nonaccrual
     Total
Current
     Total Loans
Receivable
 

Local

   $ 327       $ —         $ —         $ 597       $ 924       $ 158,501       $ 159,425   

National

     —           —           —           —           —           146,966         146,966   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ 327    $ —      $ —      $ 597    $ 924    $ 305,467    $ 306,391   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aged Analysis of Dental Loans Receivable

As of December 31, 2013

 

     30-59 Days
Past Due
Still Accruing
     60-89 Days
Past Due
Still Accruing
     Greater Than
90 Days
Still Accruing
     Nonaccrual      Total Past
Due and
Nonaccrual
     Total
Current
     Total Loans
Receivable
 

Local

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ 2,176       $ 2,176       $ 176,497       $ 178,673   

National

     —           —           —           224         224         128,371         128,595   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

$ —      $ —      $ —      $ 2,400    $ 2,400    $ 304,868    $ 307,268   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

93


Table of Contents

NOTE 5 – LOAN PARTICIPATIONS AND SERVICING:

In the normal course of business the Company may sell portions of loans to other institutions for cash in order to extend its lending capacity or to mitigate risk. These sales are commonly referred to as loan participations. Loan participations are performed without recourse and the participant’s interest is ratably concurrent with that retained by the Company. Cash flows are shared proportionately and neither the Company’s nor the participant’s interest is subordinated. The Company retains servicing rights and manages the client relationships for a reasonable servicing fee. The participated portion of these loans is not included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the servicing component of these transactions are not material to the consolidated financial statements. The Company’s exposure to loss is limited to its retained interest in the loans.

The following table reflects the amounts of loans participated.

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013  

Total principal amount outstanding

   $ 22,840       $ 25,179   

less: principal amount derecognized

     (11,821      (13,268
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Principal amount included in loans on the balance sheet

$ 11,019    $ 11,911   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

NOTE 6 – PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT:

The balance of property and equipment net of accumulated depreciation and amortization at December 31, 2014, and 2013 consists of the following:

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013  

Land

   $ 3,831       $ 3,831   

Buildings and improvements

     19,056         19,039   

Furniture and equipment

     12,835         12,424   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
  35,722      35,294   

less: accumulated depreciation & amortization

  (17,902   (16,458
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net property and equipment

$ 17,820    $ 18,836   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Depreciation expense was $1,491, $1,495, and $1,482, for the years ended December 31, 2014, and 2013, and 2012, respectively.

The Company leases certain facilities for office locations under non-cancelable operating lease agreements expiring through 2027. Rent expense related to these leases totaled $1,324, $1,381, and $1,141, in 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. The Company leases approximately 26.00% of its Springfield Gateway building to others under non-cancelable operating lease agreements extending through 2016.

 

94


Table of Contents

Future minimum payments required and anticipated lease revenues under these leases are:

 

     Lease
Commitments
     Property
Leased
to Others
 

2015

   $ 1,265       $ 247   

2016

     950         227   

2017

     958         —     

2018

     841         —     

2019

     717         —     

Thereafter

     2,229         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 6,960    $ 474   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

NOTE 7 – GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS:

The following table summarizes the changes in the Company’s goodwill and core deposit intangible asset for the three years ended December 31:

 

     Goodwill      Core
Deposit
Intangible
     Total  

Balance, December 31, 2011

   $ 22,031       $ 204       $ 22,235   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amortization

  —        (204   (204
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2012

$ 22,031    $ —      $ 22,031   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amortization

  —        (110   (110

Increase due to Century Bank acquisition

  850      845      1,695   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2013

$ 22,881    $ 735    $ 23,616   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amortization

  —        (121   (121
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2014

$ 22,881    $ 614    $ 23,495   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2014, the Company had a recorded balance of $22,881 in goodwill from the November 30, 2005, acquisition of Northwest Business Financial Corporation (“NWBF”) and the February 1, 2013, acquisition of Century Bank. In addition, the Company had $614 of core deposit intangible assets resulting from the acquisition of Century Bank. The Century Bank core deposit intangible was determined to have an expected life of seven years, and is being amortized over that period using the straight-line method. The Century Bank core deposit intangible will be fully amortized in January 2020.

 

95


Table of Contents

NOTE 8 – DEPOSITS:

Scheduled maturities or repricing of time deposits at December 31, are as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013  

2014

   $ —         $ 86,821   

2015

     90,042         13,501   

2016

     9,813         15,431   

2017

     12,554         14,609   

2018

     10,079         8,592   

2019

     4,161         —     

Thereafter

     29,032         25,504   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 155,681    $ 164,458   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Time deposits with balances of $250 or greater were $69,785 and $59,931 at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

NOTE 9 – FEDERAL FUNDS AND OVERNIGHT FUNDS PURCHASED:

The Company has unsecured federal funds borrowing lines with various correspondent banks totaling $129,000 at December 31, 2014 and 2013. At December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013 there was $0 and $5,150 outstanding on these lines, respectively.

The Company also has a secured overnight borrowing line available from the Federal Reserve Bank that totaled $65,084 and $92,379 at December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, respectively. The Federal Reserve Bank borrowing line is secured through the pledging of approximately $142,523 of commercial loans under the Company’s Borrower-In-Custody program. At December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, there were no outstanding borrowings on this line.

NOTE 10 – FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK BORROWINGS:

The Company has a borrowing limit with the FHLB equal to 30.00% of total assets, subject to discounted collateral. The

Company does have the ability to access the FHLB excess stock pool, thus borrowing is not limited by FHLB stock held.

At December 31, 2014, the maximum borrowing line was $451,298; however, the FHLB borrowing line was limited by the discounted value of collateral pledged. The Company had pledged $483,521 in real estate loans to the FHLB that had a discounted value of $318,854. There was $96,000 borrowed on this line at December 31, 2014.

At December 31, 2013, the maximum FHLB borrowing line was $434,963, and the Company had pledged real estate loans and securities to the FHLB with a discounted value of $229,547. There was $160,000 borrowed on this line at December 31, 2013.

 

96


Table of Contents

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings by year of maturity and applicable interest rate are summarized as follows as of December 31:

 

     Current     December 31,  
     Rates     2014      2013  

Cash management advance

     —        $ —         $ —     

2014

     NA        —           119,000   

2015

     0.25% - 1.60     68,500         13,500   

2016

     1.84% - 2.36     22,500         22,500   

2017

     2.28     3,000         3,000   

2018

     —          —           —     

2019

     —          —           —     

Thereafter

     3.85     2,000         2,000   
    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 96,000    $ 160,000   
    

 

 

    

 

 

 

NOTE 11 – JUNIOR SUBORDINATED DEBENTURES:

In connection with the November 2005 acquisition of NWB Financial Corporation, the Company formed a wholly owned Delaware statutory business trust subsidiary, Pacific Continental Corporation Capital Trust (the “Trust”), which issued $8,248 of guaranteed undivided beneficial interests in the Company’s Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest Debentures (“Trust Preferred Securities”). These debentures qualify as Tier 1 capital under Federal Reserve Board guidelines. All of the common securities of the Trust are owned by the Company. The proceeds from the issuance of the common securities and the Trust Preferred Securities were used by the Trust to purchase $8,248 of junior subordinated debentures of the Company. The debentures, which represent the sole asset of the Trust, accrued and paid distributions quarterly at a fixed rate of 6.265% per annum of the stated liquidation value of $1 per capital security. At January 7, 2012, the interest rate changed to a variable rate of three-month LIBOR plus 135 basis points. See Note 12 for additional information regarding the interest rate swap agreement executed on the debenture in 2013.

The Company has entered into contractual arrangements which, taken collectively, fully and unconditionally guarantee payment of (1) accrued and unpaid distributions required to be paid on the Trust Preferred Securities, (2) the redemption price with respect to any Trust Preferred Securities called for redemption by the Trust, and (3) payments due upon a voluntary or involuntary dissolution, winding up, or liquidation of the Trust. The Trust Preferred Securities are mandatorily redeemable upon maturity of the debentures on January 7, 2036, or upon earlier redemption as provided in the indenture. The Company has the right to redeem the debentures purchased by the Trust in whole or in part, on or after, January 7, 2012. As specified in the indenture, if the debentures are redeemed prior to maturity, the redemption price will be the principal amount and any accrued interest. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, the Company recognized net interest expense of $225, $200, and $151, respectively, related to the Trust Preferred Securities.

NOTE 12 – DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS:

Derivative instruments are entered into primarily as a risk management tool of the Company to help manage its interest rate risk position. Financial derivatives are recorded at fair value as other assets and other liabilities. The accounting for changes in the fair value of a derivative depends on whether it has been designated and qualifies as part of a hedging relationship. For a fair value hedge, changes in the fair value of the derivative instrument and changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability are recognized currently in earnings. For a cash flow hedge, changes in the fair value of the derivative instrument, to the extent that it is effective, are recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income and subsequently reclassified to earnings as the hedged transaction impacts net income. Any ineffective portion of a cash flow hedge is recognized currently in earnings.

During the second quarter 2013, the Company entered into an interest rate swap agreement with an $8,000 notional amount to convert its variable-rate Junior Subordinated Debenture debt into a fixed rate for a term of approximately 7 years at a rate of 2.73%. The derivative is designated as a cash flow hedge. The hedge meets the definition of highly effective and the Company expects the hedge to be highly effective throughout the remaining term of the swap. The fair value of the derivative instrument at December 31, 2014, was a $176 unrealized gain, which is recorded in the other asset section of the balance sheet, net of the tax effect. No gain or loss was recognized in earnings for the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, related to interest rate swaps.

 

97


Table of Contents

The Company maintains written documentation for the hedge. This documentation identifies the hedging objective and strategy, the hedging instrument, the instrument being hedged, the reasoning behind the assertion that the hedge is highly effective and the methodology for measuring ongoing hedge effectiveness and ineffectiveness. The Company pledged $400 under collateral arrangements as of April 22, 2013, to satisfy collateral requirements associated with the interest rate swap contract.

 

98


Table of Contents

NOTE 13 – INCOME TAXES:

The provision for income taxes for the years ended December 31 consists of the following:

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Current payable:

        

Federal

   $ 5,747       $ 6,682       $ 6,423   

State

     159         (209      50   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  5,906      6,473      6,473   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred:

Federal

  1,608      (496   (1,152

State

  1,158      1,239      838   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  2,766      743      (314
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total income tax provision

$ 8,672    $ 7,216    $ 6,159   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

99


Table of Contents

The provision (benefit) for income taxes results in effective tax rates which are different than the federal income tax statutory rate. The nature of the differences for the years ended December 31 was as follows:

 

     2014     2013     2012  

Expected federal income tax provision

   $ 8,650        35.00   $ 7,344        35.00   $ 6,584        35.00

State income tax, net of federal income tax effect

     948        3.84     908        4.33     775        4.12

Municipal securities tax benefit

     (747     -3.02     (735     -3.50     (631     -3.35

Equity-based compensation

     5        0.02     27        0.13     25        0.13

Benefit of purchased tax credits

     25        0.10     (150     -0.71     (181     -0.96

Low-income housing tax credits

     (199     -0.81     (142     -0.68     (142     -0.75

Bank Owned Life Insurance

     (184     -0.74     (201     -0.96     (228     -1.21

Acquisition Costs—Century Bank

     150        0.61     106        0.51     —          —     

Deferred tax rate adjustments and other

     24        0.10     59        0.28     (43     -0.24
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax provision

$ 8,672      35.10 $ 7,216      34.40 $ 6,159      32.74
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The excess tax benefit associated with stock option plans reduced taxes payable by $14, $0, and $10, at December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. Such benefit is credited to common stock.

 

100


Table of Contents

The components of deferred tax assets and liabilities at December 31 are as follows:

 

     2014      2013  

Assets:

     

Allowance for loan losses

   $ 6,555       $ 6,916   

Basis adjustments on loans

     1,039         2,252   

Reserve for self-funded insurance

     78         180   

Oregon purchased tax credits

     720         1,669   

Nonqualified stock options

     945         1,278   

Accrued compensation

     823         724   

OTTI credit impairment

     88         89   

Nonaccrual loan interest

     23         52   

Net unrealized loss on securities

     —           95   

Other

     76         61   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

  10,347      13,316   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities:

Federal Home Loan Bank stock dividends

  591      593   

Excess tax over book depreciation

  1,125      1,299   

Prepaid expenses

  364      345   

NWBF acquisition adjustments

  205      225   

Loan origination fees

  1,132      1,046   

Net unrealized gains on Swap

  69      158   

Net unrealized gains on securities

  2,362      —     

Other

  35      52   

Total deferred tax liabilities

  5,883      3,718   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

$ 4,464    $ 9,598   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Purchased tax credits of $720 will be utilized to offset future state income taxes. These credits are recognized over a five-year period beginning in the year of purchase and have an eight year carry forward period. If unused the credits will expire in the following years: $423 in 2021, $261 in 2022, $3 in 2023 and $3 in 2024. It is anticipated that all credits and other deferred asset items will be fully utilized in the normal course of operations and, accordingly, management has not reduced deferred tax assets by a valuation allowance.

NOTE 14 – RETIREMENT PLAN:

The Company has a 401(k) profit sharing plan covering substantially all employees. The plan provides for employee and employer contributions. The total plan expenses, including employer contributions, were $740, $673, and $617 in 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively.

NOTE 15 – SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION:

The Company’s 2006 Stock Option and Equity Compensation Plan (the “2006 SOEC Plan”) authorizes the award of up to 1,550,000 shares in stock-based awards. The awards granted under this plan are service-based and are subject to vesting. The Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors may impose any terms or conditions on the vesting of an award that it determines to be appropriate. Awards granted generally vest over four years and have a maximum life of ten years. Awards may be granted at exercise prices of not less than 100.00% of the fair market value of the Company’s common stock at the grant date.

Pursuant to the 2006 SOEC Plan, incentive stock options (“ISOs”), nonqualified stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units (“RSUs”), or stock appreciation rights (“SARs”) may be awarded to attract and retain the best available personnel to the Corporation and its subsidiaries. SARs may be settled in common stock or cash as determined at the date of issuance. Liability-based awards (including all cash-settled SARs) have no impact on the number of shares available to be issued within the plan. Additionally, non-qualified option awards and restricted stock awards may be granted to directors under the terms of this plan.

 

101


Table of Contents

Prior to April 2006, incentive stock option (“ISO”) and non-qualified option awards were granted to employees and directors under the Company’s 1999 Employees’ Stock Option Plan and the Company’s 1999 Directors’ Stock Option Plan. The Company has stock options outstanding under both of these plans. Subsequent to the annual shareholders’ meeting in April 2006 all shares available under these plans were deregistered and are no longer available for future grants.

The following tables identify the compensation expenses recorded and tax benefits received by the Company in conjunction with its share-based compensation plans for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012:

 

     2014      2013      2012  
     Compensation
Expense
     Tax Benefit      Compensation
Expense
     Tax Benefit      Compensation
Expense
     Tax Benefit  

Equity-based awards:

                 

Director restricted stock

   $ 200       $ 70       $ 110       $ 39       $ 70       $ 25   

Director stock options

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Employee stock options

     13         —           70         —           122         —     

Employee stock SARs

     26         9         126         44         193         68   

Employee RSUs

     1,214         425         830         291         490         172   

Liability-based awards:

                 

Employee cash SARs

     75         26         60         21         —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 1,528    $ 530    $ 1,196    $ 395    $ 875    $ 265   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

102


Table of Contents

Prior to 2011, the Company granted stock options to selected employees and directors. The following table summarizes information about stock option activity under all plans for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012:

 

     2014      2013      2012  
     Options
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
     Options
Outstanding
     Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
     Options
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
 

Balance, beginning of year

     367,906      $ 14.15         367,906       $ 14.15         412,943      $ 13.74   

Granted

     —          —           —           —           —          —     

Exercised

     (16,779     11.29         —           —           (28,999     6.83   

Forfeited or expired

     (24,077     16.00         —           —           (16,038     16.86   
  

 

 

      

 

 

       

 

 

   

Balance, end of year

  327,050    $ 14.16      367,906    $ 14.15      367,906    $ 14.15   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Options exercisable, end of year

  327,050    $ 14.16      353,197    $ 14.27      312,020    $ 14.60   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

A summary of non-vested stock option activity during the current fiscal year is presented below:

 

     Non-vested
Options
     Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
 

Balance, beginning of year

     14,722       $ 4.30   

Granted

     —           —     

Vested

     (13,328      4.30   

Forfeited, expired, or exercised

     (1,394      4.30   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

  —      $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The total intrinsic value (which is the amount by which the stock price exceeds the exercise price) of both options outstanding as of December 31, 2014, was $357. The weighted average remaining contractual term of options exercisable was 3.44 years as of December 31, 2014. All stock options were vested as of December 31, 2014. There was no unrecognized compensation expense related to stock options at December 31, 2014.

Prior to 2011, the Company granted SARs settled in stock to selected employees. The following table summarizes information about activity on SARs settled in stock for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012:

 

     2014      2013      2012  
     Stock-settled
SARs
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
     Stock-settled
SARs
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
     Stock-settled
SARs
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
 

Balance, beginning of year

     337,759      $ 13.85         387,072      $ 13.74         405,340      $ 13.71   

Granted

     —          —           —          —           —          —     

Exercised

     (26,155     11.79         (30,422     12.08         —          —     

Forfeited or expired

     (22,337     14.74         (18,891     14.73         (18,268     13.07   
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

   

Balance, end of year

  289,267    $ 13.97      337,759    $ 13.85      387,072    $ 13.74   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stock-settled SARs exercisable, end of year

  289,267    $ 13.97      313,010    $ 14.05      309,980    $ 14.28   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

103


Table of Contents

A summary of non-vested stock-settled SARs activity during the current fiscal year is presented below:

 

     Non-vested
Stock-settled
SARs
     Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
 

Balance, beginning of year

     24,749       $ 4.06   

Granted

     —           —     

Vested

     (21,166      4.06   

Forfeited, expired, or exercised

     (3,583      4.06   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

  —      $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The total intrinsic value (which is the amount by which the stock price exceeds the exercise price) of stock-settled SARs as of December 31, 2014, was $347. The weighted average remaining contractual term of exercisable stock-settled SARs was 3.59 years as of December 31, 2014. As of December 31, 2014, there was no unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested stock-settled SARs.

Prior to 2010, the Company granted SARs settled in cash to selected employees. The following table summarizes information about activity on SARs settled in cash for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012:

 

     2014      2013      2012  
     Cash-settled
SARs
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
     Cash-settled
SARs
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
     Cash-settled
SARs
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
 

Balance, beginning of year

     186,992      $ 14.95         206,763      $ 14.84         230,607      $ 14.81   

Granted

     —          —           —          —           —          —     

Exercised

     (11,012     12.21         (8,353     12.55         —          —     

Forfeited or expired

     (16,987     15.34         (11,418     14.73         (23,844     14.50   
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

   

Balance, end of year

  158,993    $ 15.10      186,992    $ 14.95      206,763    $ 14.84   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash-settled SARs exercisable, end of year

  158,993    $ 15.10      186,992    $ 14.95      190,236    $ 15.09   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2014, there was an intrinsic value of $89 on the Company’s outstanding cash-settled SARs. The weighted average remaining contractual term of exercisable cash-settled SARs was 2.92 years as of December 31, 2014.

 

104


Table of Contents

The following tables identify stock options, employee stock SARs, and employee cash SARs exercised during the period ending December 31, 2014 and 2013:

 

     Twelve months ended
December 31, 2014
 
     Number
Exercised
     Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
     Intrinsic
Value
     Number of
Shares
Issued
     Net Cash
Payment to
Employees
 

Stock options

     16,779       $ 11.29       $ 57         —           NA   

Employee stock SARs

     26,155       $ 11.79       $ 40         2,776         NA   

Employee cash SARs

     11,012       $ 12.21         NA         NA       $ 13   

 

     Twelve months ended
December 31, 2013
 
     Number
Exercised
     Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
     Intrinsic
Value
     Number of
Shares
Issued
     Net Cash
Payment to
Employees
 

Stock options

     —         $ —         $ —           —           NA   

Employee stock SARs

     30,422       $ 12.08       $ 57         3,742         NA   

Employee cash SARs

     8,353       $ 12.55         NA         NA       $ 12   

In 2011, the Company began granting RSUs to selected employees. Company’s RSUs do not accrue dividends and the grantees do not have voting rights. In 2014 the company granted 127,051 restricted stock units, 378 vesting immediately, 9,902 vesting over a two year period and 116,771 vesting over a four year period. In 2013 and 2012 all restricted stock units vested equally over a four year period.

The following table provides information regarding RSU activity during 2014, 2013 and 2012:

 

     2014      2013      2012  
     Restricted
Stock Units
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Grant
Date Fair
Value
     Restricted
Stock Units
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Grant Date

Fair Value
     Restricted
Stock Units
Outstanding
    Weighted
Average
Grant Date

Fair Value
 

Balance, beginning of year

     299,696      $ 9.79         251,329      $ 8.99         125,888      $ 9.40   

Granted

     127,051        13.21         145,420        10.80         164,519        8.76   

Vested shares issued

     (58,518     9.65         (42,678     9.03         (18,821     9.40   

Vested shares forfeited for taxes

     (36,384     9.65         (26,580     9.03         (11,517     9.40   

Forfeited or expired

     (25,313     10.67         (27,795     9.66         (8,740     9.20   
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

   

Balance, end of year

  306,532    $ 11.18      299,696    $ 9.79      251,329    $ 8.99   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Under the terms of the 2006 SOEC Plan, shares of Pacific Continental Corporation common stock are to be issued as soon as is practicable upon vesting of RSUs.

 

105


Table of Contents

NOTE 16 – DEFERRED COMPENSATION PLAN:

During 2014, the company established a nonqualified deferred compensation plan for certain eligible executives and eligible directors. Under the deferred compensation plan, eligible executives and eligible directors may elect to defer a portion of their base salary, bonuses, director fees, and/or long-term incentive compensation. At December 31, 2014, the deferred compensation liability totaled $72 and is recorded in other liabilities.

 

106


Table of Contents

NOTE 17 – TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES:

The Company has granted loans to officers and directors and to companies with which they are associated. Such loans are made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with unrelated parties. Activity with respect to these loans during the year ended December 31 was as follows:

 

     2014      2013      2012  

Balance, beginning of year

   $ 100       $ 133       $ 994   

Additions or renewals

     —           68         49   

Amounts collected

     —           (101      (16

No longer related party

     —           —           (894
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

$ 100    $ 100    $ 133   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In addition, there were $12 in commitments to extend credit to directors and officers at December 31, 2014, which are included among loan commitments, disclosed in Note 18.

NOTE 18 – COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES:

In the normal course of business under the provisions of the Company’s investment policy, additional investment securities may be purchased from time to time. Commitments to purchase securities are generally settled within a month and are not associated with repurchase agreements.

In order to meet the financing needs of its clients, the Company commits to extensions of credit and issues letters of credit. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as it does for other products. In the event of nonperformance by the client, the Company’s exposure to credit loss is represented by the contractual amount of the instruments. The Company’s collateral policies related to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk conform to its general underwriting guidelines.

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a client as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since some of the commitments may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements.

Letters of credit written are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a client to a third-party. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to clients.

Off-balance sheet instruments at December 31 consist of the following:

 

     2014      2013  

Commitments to purchase securities

   $ —         $ 1,490   

Commitments to extend credit (principally variable rate)

   $ 156,972       $ 167,374   

Letters of credit and financial guarantees written

   $ 1,564       $ 1,304   

The Company has entered into Executive Employment Agreements with two key executive officers. The employment agreements provide for minimum aggregate annual base salaries of $725, plus performance adjustments, life insurance coverage, and other perquisites commonly found in such agreements. The two employment agreements expire in 2015 unless extended or terminated earlier.

 

107


Table of Contents

Legal contingencies arise from time-to-time in the normal course of business. Based upon analysis of management and in consultation with the Company’s legal counsel there are no current legal matters which are expected to have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position.

NOTE 19 – FAIR VALUE:

The following disclosures about fair value of financial instruments are made in accordance with provisions of ASC 825 “Financial Instruments.” The use of different assumptions and estimation methods could have a significant effect on fair value amounts. Accordingly, the estimates of fair value herein are not necessarily indicative of the amounts that might be realized in a current market exchange.

The estimated fair values of the financial instruments at December 31 are as follows:

 

     2014      2013  
     Carrying             Carrying         
     Amount      Fair Value      Amount      Fair Value  

Financial assets:

           

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 25,787       $ 25,787       $ 21,108       $ 21,108   

Securities available-for-sale

     351,946         351,946         347,386         347,386   

Loans

     1,045,021         1,033,254         993,845         980,334   

Interest receivable

     4,773         4,773         4,703         4,703   

Federal Home Loan Bank stock

     10,019         10,019         10,425         10,425   

Bank-owned life insurance

     16,609         16,609         16,136         16,136   

Swap Derivative

     176         176         405         405   

Financial liabilities:

           

Deposits

   $ 1,209,093       $ 1,209,240       $ 1,090,981       $ 1,091,355   

Federal funds and overnight funds purchased

     —           —           5,150         5,150   

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

     96,000         96,721         160,000         160,984   

Junior subordinated debentures

     8,248         2,410         8,248         2,265   

Accrued interest payable

     176         176         193         193   

Cash and Cash Equivalents – The carrying amount approximates fair value.

Securities available-for-sale– Fair value is based on quoted market prices. If a quoted market price is not available, fair value is estimated using quoted market prices for similar securities.

Accrued Interest receivable– The carrying amounts of accrued interest receivable approximate their fair value.

Loans – For variable rate loans that reprice frequently and have no significant change in credit risk, fair value is based on carrying values. Fair value of fixed rate loans is estimated by discounting the future cash flows using current rates at which similar loans would be made to borrowers with similar credit ratings and for the same remaining maturities. Fair values for impaired loans are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses or underlying collateral values, where applicable, and consider credit risk.

Federal Home Loan Bank stock – The carrying amount approximates fair value.

Bank-owned life insurance – The carrying amount approximates fair value.

Swap Derivative – Fair value is based on quoted market prices.

Deposits – Fair value of demand, interest bearing demand and savings deposits is the amount payable on demand at the reporting date. Fair value of time deposits is estimated using the interest rates currently offered for deposits of similar remaining maturities.

 

108


Table of Contents

Federal Funds and Overnight Funds Purchased – The carrying amount is a reasonable estimate of fair value because of the short-term nature of these borrowings.

Federal Home Loan Bank Borrowings – Fair value of Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings is estimated by discounting future cash flows at rates currently available for debt with similar terms and remaining maturities.

Junior Subordinated Debentures – Fair value of Junior Subordinated Debentures is estimated by discounting future cash flows at rates currently available for debt with similar credit risk, terms and remaining maturities.

Accrued Interest payable – The carrying amounts of accrued interest payable approximate their fair value

Off-Balance Sheet Financial Instruments – The carrying amount and fair value are based on fees charged for similar commitments and are not material.

The Company also adheres to the FASB guidance with regards to ASC 820, “Fair Value Measures.” This guidance defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value in generally accepted accounting principles, and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. The statement requires fair value measurement disclosure of all assets and liabilities that are carried at fair value on either a recurring or nonrecurring basis. The Company determines fair value based upon quoted prices when available or through the use of alternative approaches, such as matrix or model pricing, when market quotes are not readily accessible or available. The valuation techniques used are based on observable and unobservable inputs. Observable inputs reflect market data obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect the Company’s market assumptions. These two types of inputs create the following fair value hierarchy:

Level 1 – Quoted prices for identical instruments in active markets.

Level 2 – Quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active or model-derived valuations whose inputs are observable or whose significant value drivers are observable.

Level 3 – Unobservable inputs are used to measure fair value to the extent that observable inputs are not available. The Company’s own data used to develop unobservable inputs is adjusted for market consideration when reasonably available.

Financial instruments, measured at fair value, are broken down in the tables below by recurring or nonrecurring measurement status. Recurring assets are initially measured at fair value and are required to be remeasured at fair value in the financial statements at each reporting date. Assets measured on a nonrecurring basis are assets that, due to an event or circumstance, were required to be remeasured at fair value after initial recognition in the financial statements at some time during the reporting period.

 

109


Table of Contents

The following table presents information about the level in the fair value hierarchy for the Company’s assets and liabilities not measured at fair value as of December 31, 2014, and 2013:

 

     Carrying
Amount
     Fair Value at December 31, 2014  
        Level 1      Level 2      Level 3  

Financial assets:

           

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 25,787       $ 25,787       $ —         $ —     

Loans

     1,045,021         —           —           1,033,254   

Interest receivable

     4,773         4,773         —           —     

Federal Home Loan Bank stock

     10,019         10,019         —           —     

Bank-owned life insurance

     16,609         16,609         —           —     

Swap Derivative

     176         176         —           —     

Financial liabilities:

           

Deposits

   $ 1,209,093       $ —         $ 1,209,240       $ —     

Federal funds and overnight funds purchased

     —           —           —           —     

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

     96,000         —           96,721         —     

Junior subordinated debentures

     8,248         —           2,410         —     

Accrued interest payable

     176         176         —           —     
     Carrying
Amount
     Fair Value at December 31, 2013  
        Level 1      Level 2      Level 3  

Financial assets:

           

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 21,108       $ 21,108       $ —         $ —     

Loans

     993,845         —           —           980,334   

Interest receivable

     4,703         4,703         —           —     

Federal Home Loan Bank stock

     10,425         10,425         —           —     

Bank-owned life insurance

     16,136         16,136         —           —     

Swap Derivative

     405         405         —           —     

Financial liabilities:

           

Deposits

   $ 1,090,981       $ —         $ 1,091,355       $ —     

Federal funds and overnight funds purchased

     5,150         5,150         —           —     

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

     160,000         —           160,984         —     

Junior subordinated debentures

     8,248         —           2,265         —     

Accrued interest payable

     193         193         —           —     

 

110


Table of Contents

The tables below show assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013:

 

     Carrying
Value
     Fair Value Measurements Using  

December 31, 2014

      Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
 

Available-for-sale securities

           

Obligations of U.S government agencies

   $ 39,185       $ —         $ 39,185       $ —     

Obligation of states and political subdivisions

     83,981         —           83,981         —     

Agency mortgage-backed securities

     205,390         —           205,390         —     

Private-label mortgage-backed securities

     3,816         —           2,248         1,568   

SBA variable vate pools

     19,574         —           19,574         —     

Swap Derivative

     176         176         —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets measured on a recurring basis

$ 352,122    $ 176    $ 350,378    $ 1,568   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Carrying
Value
     Fair Value Measurements Using  

December 31, 2013

      Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
 

Available-for-sale securities

           

Obligations of U.S government agencies

   $ 30,847       $ —         $ 30,847       $ —     

Obligation of states and political subdivisions

     78,795         —           78,795         —     

Agency mortgage-backed securities

     223,720         —           223,720         —     

Private-label mortgage-backed securities

     5,314         —           3,528         1,786   

SBA variable vate pools

     8,710         —           8,710         —     

Swap Derivative

     405         405         —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets measured on a recurring basis

$ 347,791    $ 405    $ 345,600    $ 1,786   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

No transfers to or from level 1 and 2 occurred on assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis during the twelve months ended December 31, 2014.

The following is a description of the inputs and valuation methodologies used for assets recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Fair value for all classes of available-for-sale securities is estimated by obtaining quoted market prices for identical assets, where available. If such prices are not available, fair value is based on independent asset pricing services and models, the inputs of which are market-based or independently sourced market parameters, including, but not limited to, yield curves, interest rates, prepayments, defaults, cumulative loss projections, and cash flows. There have been no significant changes in the valuation techniques during the periods reported.

 

111


Table of Contents

The following table provides a reconciliation of assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis using unobservable inputs (Level 3) from December 31, 2013, to December 31, 2014:

 

     2014      2013  

Beginning balance

   $ 1,786       $ 1,682   

Transfers into Level 3

     —           332   

Transfers out of Level 3

     —           —     

Total gains or losses

     

Included in earnings

     —           —     

Included in other comprehensive income

     (106      80   

Paydowns

     (112      (308

Purchases, issuances, sales, and settlements

     

Purchases

     —           —     

Issuances

     —           —     

Sales

     —           —     

Settlements

     —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ending balance

$ 1,568    $ 1,786   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair value for all classes of available-for-sale securities is estimated by obtaining quoted market prices for identical assets, where available. If such prices are not available, fair value is based on quoted prices for similar instruments or model-derived valuations whose inputs are observable or whose significant value drivers are observable. In instances where quoted prices for identical or similar instruments and observable inputs are not available, unobservable inputs, including the Company’s own data, are used.

The Company utilizes FTN Financial as an independent third-party asset pricing service to estimate fair value on all of its available-for-sale securities. The inputs used to value all securities include benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, two-sided markets, benchmark securities, bids, offers, and reference data including market research, market indicators, and industry and economic trends. Additional inputs specific to each asset type are as follows:

 

    Obligations of U.S. government agencies – TRACE reported trades.

 

    Obligations of states and political subdivisions – MSRB reported trades, material event notices, and Municipal Market Data (MMD) benchmark yields.

 

    Private-label mortgage-backed securities – new issue data, monthly payment information, and collateral performance (whole loan collateral).

 

    Mortgage-backed securities – TBA prices and monthly payment information.

 

112


Table of Contents

Inputs may be prioritized differently on any given day for any security and not all inputs listed are available for use in the evaluation process on any given day for each security evaluation.

The valuation methodology used by asset type includes:

 

    Obligations of U.S. government agencies – security characteristics, defined sector break-down, benchmark yields, applied base spread, yield to maturity (bullet structures), corporate action adjustment, and evaluations based on T+3 settlement.

 

    Obligations of states and political subdivisions – security characteristics, benchmark yields, applied base spread, yield to worst or market convention, ratings updates, prepayment schedules (housing bonds), material event notice adjustments, and evaluations based on T+3 settlement.

 

    Private-label mortgage-backed securities – security characteristics, prepayment speeds, cash flows, TBA, Treasury and swap curves, IO/PO strips or floating indexes, applied base spread, spread adjustments, yield to worst or market convention, ratings updates (whole-loan collateral), and evaluations based on T+0 settlement.

 

    Mortgage-backed securities – security characteristics, TBA, Treasury, or floating index benchmarks, spread to TBA levels, prepayment speeds, applied spreads, and evaluations based on T+0 settlement.

The third-party pricing service follows multiple review processes to assess the available market, credit and deal-level information to support its valuation estimates. If sufficient objectively verifiable information is not available to support a security’s valuation, an alternate independent evaluation source will be used.

The Company’s securities portfolio was valued through its independent third-party pricing service using evaluated pricing models and quoted prices based on market data. For further assurance, the Company’s estimate of fair value was compared to an additional independent third-party estimate at June 27, 2014, and the Company obtained key inputs for a sample of securities across sectors and evaluated those inputs for reasonableness. This analysis was performed at the individual security level and no material variances were noted.

There have been no significant changes in the valuation techniques during the periods reported.

 

113


Table of Contents

The tables below show assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis as of December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013:

 

            Fair Value Measurements Using  
December 31, 2014    Carrying
Value
     Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
 

Loans measured for impairment (net of guarantees and specific reserve)

   $ 3,110       $ —         $ —         $ 3,110   

Other real estate owned

     13,374         —           —           13,374   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  16,484      —        —        16,484   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
            Fair Value Measurements Using  
December 31, 2013    Carrying
Value
     Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
 

Loans measured for impairment (net of guarantees and specific reserve)

   $ 5,749       $ —         $ —         $ 5,749   

Other real estate owned

     16,355         —           —           16,355   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 22,104    $ —      $ —      $ 22,104   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

No transfers to or from Level 3 occurred during 2014 or 2013 on assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis.

The following is a description of the inputs and valuation methodologies used for assets recorded at fair value on a nonrecurring basis.

Loans measured for impairment (net of government guarantees and specific reserves) include the estimated fair value of collateral-dependent loans, less collectible government guarantees, as well as certain noncollateral-dependent loans measured for impairment with an allocated specific reserve. When a collateral-dependent loan is identified as impaired, the value of the loan is measured using the current fair value of the collateral less selling costs. The fair value of collateral is generally estimated by obtaining external appraisals which are usually updated every 6 to 12 months based on the nature of the impaired loans. Certain noncollateral-dependent loans measured for impairment with an allocated specific reserve are valued based upon the estimated net realizable value of the loan. If the estimated fair value of the impaired loan, less collectible government guarantees, is less than the recorded investment in the loan, impairment is recognized as a charge-off through the allowance for loan losses. The carrying value of the loan is adjusted to the estimated fair value. The carrying value of loans fully charged off is zero.

Other real estate owned represents real estate which the Company has taken control of in partial or full satisfaction of loans. At the time of foreclosure, other real estate owned is recorded at the lower of the carrying amount of the loan or fair value less costs to sell, which becomes the property’s new basis. Any write downs based on the asset’s fair value at the date of acquisition are charged to the allowance for loan losses. After foreclosure, management periodically orders appraisals or performs valuations to ensure that the real estate is carried at the lower of its new cost basis or fair value, net of estimated costs to sell. Appraisals are generally updated every 6 to 12 months on other real estate owned. Fair value adjustments on other real estate owned are recognized within net loss on real estate owned. The loss represents impairments on other real estate owned for fair value adjustments based on the fair value of the real estate.

There have been no significant changes in the valuation techniques during the periods reported.

 

114


Table of Contents

NOTE 20 – REGULATORY MATTERS:

The Company and the Bank are subject to the regulations of certain federal and state agencies and receive periodic examinations by those regulatory authorities. In addition, they are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory – and possibly additional discretionary – actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the consolidated financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Bank’s assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The Company and the Bank’s capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios of Total and Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets and of Tier 1 capital to leverage assets. Management believes that, as of December 31, 2014, the Company and the Bank meet all capital adequacy requirements to which they are subject.

As of December 31, 2014, according to FDIC guidelines, the Bank is considered to be well-capitalized. To be categorized as well-capitalized, the Bank must maintain minimum Total risk-based, Tier 1 risk-based and Tier 1 leverage ratios as set forth in the following table.

 

115


Table of Contents

The Company’s and the Bank’s actual capital amounts and ratios are presented in the table below:

 

     Actual     For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
    To Be Well
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provisions
 
     Amount      Ratio     Amount      Ratio     Amount      Ratio  

As of December 31, 2014:

               

Total capital (to risk weighted assets)

               

Bank:

   $ 176,199         15.48   $ 91,040         8   $ 113,800         10

Company:

   $ 179,109         15.73     NA           NA      

Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)

               

Bank:

   $ 161,954         14.23   $ 45,520         4   $ 68,280         6

Company:

   $ 164,864         14.48     NA           NA      

Tier 1 capital (to leverage assets)

               

Bank:

   $ 161,954         11.13   $ 58,193         4   $ 72,741         5

Company:

   $ 164,864         11.33     NA           NA      

As of December 31, 2013:

               

Total capital (to risk weighted assets)

               

Bank:

   $ 174,311         15.89   $ 87,744         8   $ 109,680         10

Company:

   $ 177,209         16.15     NA           NA      

Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)

               

Bank:

   $ 160,572         14.64   $ 43,872         4   $ 65,808         6

Company:

   $ 163,470         14.90     NA           NA      

Tier 1 capital (to leverage assets)

               

Bank:

   $ 160,572         11.29   $ 56,887         4   $ 71,109         5

Company:

   $ 163,470         11.49     NA           NA      

 

116


Table of Contents

On July 2, 2013, the federal banking regulators approved the final proposed rules that revise the regulatory capital rules to incorporate certain revisions by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision to the Basel capital framework (“Basel III”). The phase-in period for the final rules began for the Company on January 1, 2015, with full compliance with the final rules entire requirement phased in on January 1, 2019.

The final rules, among other things, include a new common equity Tier 1 capital (“CET1”) to risk-weighted assets ratio, including a capital conservation buffer, which will gradually increase from 4.50% on January 1, 2015 to 7.00% on January 1, 2019. The final rules also raise the minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets from 4.00% to 6.00% on January 1, 2015 to 8.50% on January 1, 2019, as well as require a minimum leverage ratio of 4.00%.

Also, under the final rules, trust preferred security debt issuances will be phased out of Tier 1 capital into Tier 2 capital over a 10 year period, except for bank holding companies with less than $15 billion assets as of December 31, 2009 will be allowed to continue to include these issuances in Tier 1 capital, subject to certain restrictions. As the Company had less than $15 billion in assets at December 31, 2009, the Company will be able to continue to include its existing trust preferred securities, less the common stock of the Trusts, in the Company’s Tier 1 capital.

NOTE 21 – PARENT COMPANY FINANCIAL INFORMATION:

Financial information for Pacific Continental Corporation (Parent Company only) is presented below:

BALANCE SHEETS

 

     December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Assets:

        

Cash deposited with the Bank

   $ 2,961       $ 2,941       $ 2,465   

Deferred tax asset

     (69      (158      —     

Prepaid expenses

     7         14         16   

Equity in Trust

     248         248         248   

Swap unrealized gain

     176         405         —     

Investment in the Bank

     189,143         184,039         188,935   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 192,466    $ 187,489    $ 191,664   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities and shareholders’ equity:

Liabilities

$ 57    $ 57    $ 35   

Junior subordinated debentures

  8,248      8,248      8,248   

Shareholders’ equity

  184,161      179,184      183,381   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
$ 192,466    $ 187,489    $ 191,664   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

117


Table of Contents

STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

For the Years Ended December 31,

 

     2014      2013      2012  

Income:

        

Cash dividends from the Bank

   $ 16,215       $ 13,995       $ 6,755   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  16,215      13,995      6,755   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses:

Interest expense

  225      200      151   

Investor relations

  84      123      124   

Legal, registration expense, and other

  132      177      128   

Personnel costs paid to Bank

  183      152      151   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  624      652      554   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income before income tax expense and equity in undistributed earnings from the Bank

  15,591      13,343      6,201   

Income tax benefit

  140      159      193   

Equity in undistributed earnings of the Bank

  311      265      6,259   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income

$ 16,042    $ 13,767    $ 12,653   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

For the Years Ended December 31,

 

     2014      2013      2012  

Cash flows from operating activities:

        

Net income

   $ 16,042       $ 13,767       $ 12,653   

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

        

Equity in undistributed earnings from the Bank

     (311      (265      (6,259

Excess tax benefit of stock options exercised

     (14      —           (10

Other, net

     525         342         98   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

  16,242      13,844      6,482   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

Proceeds from stock options exercised

  189      —        69   

Income tax benefit for stock options exercised

  14      —        10   

Repurchase of common stock

  (3,600   —        (5,676

Dividends paid

  (12,308   (13,050   (5,588

Vested RSUs surrendered to cover tax consequences

  (517   (318   (105
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

  (16,222   (13,368   (11,290
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net change in cash

  20      476      (4,808

Cash, beginning of period

  2,941      2,465      7,273   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash, end of period

$ 2,961    $ 2,941    $ 2,465   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

118


Table of Contents

NOTE 22 – SUBSEQUENT EVENTS:

On March 6, 2015, the Company completed the acquisition of Capital Pacific Bancorp. Capital Pacific shareholders received either $16.00 per share in cash or 1.132 shares of Pacific Continental common stock for each share of Capital Pacific common stock, or a combination of 40.00% in the form of cash and 60.00% in the form of Pacific Continental common stock. Pursuant to the merger agreement, the maximum aggregate cash consideration was $16,412, and the aggregate stock consideration to be issued to Capital Pacific shareholders consisted of 1,778,102 shares of Pacific Continental common stock. Based on the closing price of Pacific Continental common stock on March 6, 2015, the aggregate consideration payable for Capital Pacific Bancorp was valued at $39,990.

 

ITEM 9 Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

None

 

ITEM 9A Controls and Procedures

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

An evaluation was carried out under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”), of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures, as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”). Based on that evaluation, the CEO and CFO have concluded that, as of the end of the period covered by this report, our disclosure controls and procedures are effective to provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed by us in reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized, and timely reported as provided in the SEC rules and forms. There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act) during the three months ended December 31, 2014, that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

The management of the Company is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. This internal control system has been designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and Board of Directors regarding the preparation and fair presentation of the Company’s published financial statements.

All internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations. Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation.

The management of the Company has assessed the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting at December 31, 2014. To make this assessment, the Company used the criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting described in Internal Control – Integrated Framework, issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on this assessment, at December 31, 2014, management has determined that internal controls over financial reporting were effective to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statement in accordance with US. Generally accepted accounting principles.

 

ITEM 9B Other Information

None

 

119


Table of Contents

PART III

 

ITEM 10 Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

This Item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A, which will be filed within 120 days after the close of the fiscal year covered by this report on Form 10-K, or if our proxy statement is not filed by that date, will be included in an amendment to this Report on Form 10-K.

 

ITEM 11 Executive Compensation

This Item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A, which will be filed within 120 days after the close of the fiscal year covered by this report on Form 10-K, or if our proxy statement is not filed by that date, will be included in an amendment to this Report on Form 10-K.

 

ITEM 12 Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

This Item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A, which will be filed within 120 days after the close of the fiscal year covered by this report on Form 10-K, or if our proxy statement is not filed by that date, will be included in an amendment to this Report on Form 10-K.

 

ITEM 13 Certain Relationships and Related Transactions and Director Independence

This Item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A, which will be filed within 120 days after the close of the fiscal year covered by this report on Form 10-K, or if our proxy statement is not filed by that date, will be included in an amendment to this Report on Form 10-K.

 

ITEM 14 Principal Accountant Fees and Services

This Item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A, which will be filed within 120 days after the close of the fiscal year covered by this report on Form 10-K, or if our proxy statement is not filed by that date, will be included in an amendment to this Report on Form 10-K.

PART IV

 

ITEM 15 Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

(a)(1)(2) See Index to Consolidated Financial Statements filed under Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

All other schedules to the financial statements required by Regulation S-X are omitted because they are not applicable, not material, or because the information is included in the financial statements or related notes.

(a)(3) Exhibit Index

 

Exhibit    
  3.1   Second Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation (1)
  3.2   Amended and Restated Bylaws (2)
  4.1   Form of Indenture relating to the issuance of debentures, notes, bonds or other evidences of indebtedness (3)
10.1*   1999 Employee Stock Option Plan (4)
10.2*   1999 Director’s Stock Option Plan (4)
10.3*   Amended 2006 Stock Option and Equity Compensation Plan (5)
10.4*   Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement (6)
10.5*   Form of Stock Option Award Agreement (6)
10.6*   Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (6)
10.7*   Form of Stock Appreciation Rights Agreement (6)
10.8*   Form of Executive Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement (6)
10.9*   Form of Change in Control Agreement with executive officers (7)
10.10*+   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement for Roger Busse dated November 18, 2014
10.11*+   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement for Casey Hogan dated November 18, 2014
10.12*   NWB Financial Corporation Employee Stock Option Plan (8)

 

120


Table of Contents
10.13* NWB Financial Corporation Director Stock Option Plan (8)
10.14* Director Fee Schedule, Effective January 1, 2013 (9)
10.15* Director Stock Trading Plan (10)
10.15* Deferred Compensation Plan (11)
14.1 Code of Ethics for Senior Financial Officers and Principal Executive Officer (10)
23.1+ Consent of Moss Adams LLP
24.1+ Power of Attorney (included on signature page to this Form 10-K)
31.1+ 302 Certification, Roger S. Busse, Chief Executive Officer
31.2+ 302 Certification, Michael A. Reynolds, Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
32+ Certifications Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350
101+ The following financial information from Pacific Continental Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014, is formatted in XBRL; (i) the Audited Consolidated Balance Sheets, (ii) the Audited Consolidated Statements of Operations, (iii) the Audited Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income , (iv) the Audited Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity, (v) the Audited Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, and (vi) the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, tagged as blocks of text. As provided in Rule 406T of Regulation S-T, this information is furnished and not filed for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and is not otherwise subject to liability under those sections.

 

(1) Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the Quarter ended March 31, 2010.

 

(2) Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the Quarter ended September 30, 2008.

 

(3) Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Company’s Form S-3 Registration Statement, filed March 29, 2013.

 

(4) Incorporated by reference to Exhibits 99.1 and 99.2 of the Company’s S-8 Registration Statement (File No. 333-109501) filed October 6, 2003.

 

(5) Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010.

 

(6) Incorporated by reference to Exhibits 99.1 to 99.5 of the Company’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (File No. 333-181826) filed on June 1, 2012.

 

(7) Incorporated by reference to Exhibits 10.1, 10.2 and 10.3 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed February 2, 2013

 

(8) Incorporated by reference to Exhibits 99.1 and 99.2 of the Company’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (File No. 333-130886) filed January 1, 2006.

 

(9) Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008.

 

(10) Incorporated by reference to Exhibits 10.14 and 14 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2007.

 

(11) Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed June 30, 2014.

 

* Executive Contract, Compensatory Plan or Arrangement
+ Filed Herewith

 

121


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.

 

PACIFIC CONTINENTAL CORPORATION

(Registrant)

By: /s/ Roger S. Busse
Roger S. Busse
Chief Executive Officer
Date: March 13, 2015

Power of Attorney

Know all persons by these presents, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Roger S. Busse and Michael A. Reynolds, and each of them, as such person’s true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for such person and in such person’s name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments to the Report, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite or necessary to be done in connection therewith, as fully to all intents and purposes as such person might or could do in person, hereby, ratifying and confirming that all said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or any of them or their or such person’s substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue thereof.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated on the 13th day of March 2015.

Principal Executive Officer

 

By  /s/ Roger S. Busse Chief Executive Officer
Roger S. Busse and Director

Principal Financial and Accounting Officer

 

By  /s/ Michael A. Reynolds Executive Vice President and
Michael A. Reynolds Chief Financial Officer

Remaining Directors

 

By  /s/ Robert A. Ballin Chairman By  /s/ Michael Heijer Director
Robert A. Ballin Michael Heijer

 

By  /s/ Donald G. Montgomery Vice Chairman By  /s/ Michael D. Holzgang Director
Donald G. Montgomery Michael D. Holzgang

 

By  /s/ John H. Rickman Director By  /s/ Donald L. Krahmer, Jr. Director
John H. Rickman Donald L. Krahmer, Jr.

 

By  /s/ Jeffrey Pineo Director By  /s/ Judith Johansen Director
Jeffrey Pineo Judith Johansen

 

By  /s/ Eric Forrest Director By  /s/ Karen Whitman Director
Eric Forrest Karen Whitman

 

By  /s/ Hal M. Brown Director
Hal M. Brown

 

122